1 <!doctype debiandoc system [
2 <!-- include version information so we don't have to hard code it
3 within the document -->
4 <!entity % versiondata SYSTEM "version.ent"> %versiondata;
10 <title>Debian Policy Manual</title>
11 <author><qref id="authors">The Debian Policy Mailing List</qref></author>
12 <version>version &version;, &date;</version>
15 This manual describes the policy requirements for the Debian
16 GNU/Linux distribution. This includes the structure and
17 contents of the Debian archive and several design issues of
18 the operating system, as well as technical requirements that
19 each package must satisfy to be included in the distribution.
24 Copyright © 1996,1997,1998 Ian Jackson
25 and Christian Schwarz.
28 These are the copyright dates of the original Policy manual.
29 Since then, this manual has been updated by many others. No
30 comprehensive collection of copyright notices for subsequent
35 This manual is free software; you may redistribute it and/or
36 modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License
37 as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version
38 2, or (at your option) any later version.
42 This is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
43 <em>without any warranty</em>; without even the implied
44 warranty of merchantability or fitness for a particular
45 purpose. See the GNU General Public License for more
50 A copy of the GNU General Public License is available as
51 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL</file> in the Debian GNU/Linux
52 distribution or on the World Wide Web at
53 <url id="http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/gpl.html"
54 name="the GNU General Public Licence">. You can also
55 obtain it by writing to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
56 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
64 <heading>About this manual</heading>
66 <heading>Scope</heading>
68 This manual describes the policy requirements for the Debian
69 GNU/Linux distribution. This includes the structure and
70 contents of the Debian archive and several design issues of the
71 operating system, as well as technical requirements that
72 each package must satisfy to be included in the
77 This manual also describes Debian policy as it relates to
78 creating Debian packages. It is not a tutorial on how to build
79 packages, nor is it exhaustive where it comes to describing
80 the behavior of the packaging system. Instead, this manual
81 attempts to define the interface to the package management
82 system that the developers have to be conversant with.<footnote>
83 Informally, the criteria used for inclusion is that the
84 material meet one of the following requirements:
85 <taglist compact="compact">
86 <tag>Standard interfaces</tag>
88 The material presented represents an interface to
89 the packaging system that is mandated for use, and
90 is used by, a significant number of packages, and
91 therefore should not be changed without peer
92 review. Package maintainers can then rely on this
93 interface not changing, and the package management
94 software authors need to ensure compatibility with
95 this interface definition. (Control file and
96 changelog file formats are examples.)
98 <tag>Chosen Convention</tag>
100 If there are a number of technically viable choices
101 that can be made, but one needs to select one of
102 these options for inter-operability. The version
103 number format is one example.
106 Please note that these are not mutually exclusive;
107 selected conventions often become parts of standard
113 The footnotes present in this manual are
114 merely informative, and are not part of Debian policy itself.
118 The appendices to this manual are not necessarily normative,
119 either. Please see <ref id="pkg-scope"> for more information.
123 In the normative part of this manual,
124 the words <em>must</em>, <em>should</em> and
125 <em>may</em>, and the adjectives <em>required</em>,
126 <em>recommended</em> and <em>optional</em>, are used to
127 distinguish the significance of the various guidelines in
128 this policy document. Packages that do not conform to the
129 guidelines denoted by <em>must</em> (or <em>required</em>)
130 will generally not be considered acceptable for the Debian
131 distribution. Non-conformance with guidelines denoted by
132 <em>should</em> (or <em>recommended</em>) will generally be
133 considered a bug, but will not necessarily render a package
134 unsuitable for distribution. Guidelines denoted by
135 <em>may</em> (or <em>optional</em>) are truly optional and
136 adherence is left to the maintainer's discretion.
140 These classifications are roughly equivalent to the bug
141 severities <em>serious</em> (for <em>must</em> or
142 <em>required</em> directive violations), <em>minor</em>,
143 <em>normal</em> or <em>important</em>
144 (for <em>should</em> or <em>recommended</em> directive
145 violations) and <em>wishlist</em> (for <em>optional</em>
148 Compare RFC 2119. Note, however, that these words are
149 used in a different way in this document.
154 Much of the information presented in this manual will be
155 useful even when building a package which is to be
156 distributed in some other way or is intended for local use
162 <heading>New versions of this document</heading>
165 This manual is distributed via the Debian package
166 <package><url name="debian-policy"
167 id="http://packages.debian.org/debian-policy"></package>
168 (<httpsite>packages.debian.org</httpsite>
169 <httppath>/debian-policy</httppath>).
173 The current version of this document is also available from
174 the Debian web mirrors at
175 <tt><url name="/doc/debian-policy/"
176 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/debian-policy/"></tt>.
178 <httpsite>www.debian.org</httpsite>
179 <httppath>/doc/debian-policy/</httppath>)
180 Also available from the same directory are several other
181 formats: <file>policy.html.tar.gz</file>
182 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.html.tar.gz</httppath>),
183 <file>policy.pdf.gz</file>
184 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.pdf.gz</httppath>)
185 and <file>policy.ps.gz</file>
186 (<httppath>/doc/debian-policy/policy.ps.gz</httppath>).
190 The <package>debian-policy</package> package also includes the file
191 <file>upgrading-checklist.txt.gz</file> which indicates policy
192 changes between versions of this document.
197 <heading>Authors and Maintainers</heading>
200 Originally called "Debian GNU/Linux Policy Manual", this
201 manual was initially written in 1996 by Ian Jackson.
202 It was revised on November 27th, 1996 by David A. Morris.
203 Christian Schwarz added new sections on March 15th, 1997,
204 and reworked/restructured it in April-July 1997.
205 Christoph Lameter contributed the "Web Standard".
206 Julian Gilbey largely restructured it in 2001.
210 Since September 1998, the responsibility for the contents of
211 this document lies on the <url name="debian-policy mailing list"
212 id="mailto:debian-policy@lists.debian.org">. Proposals
213 are discussed there and inserted into policy after a certain
214 consensus is established.
215 <!-- insert shameless policy-process plug here eventually -->
216 The actual editing is done by a group of maintainers that have
217 no editorial powers. These are the current maintainers:
220 <item>Julian Gilbey</item>
221 <item>Branden Robinson</item>
222 <item>Josip Rodin</item>
223 <item>Manoj Srivastava</item>
228 While the authors of this document have tried hard to avoid
229 typos and other errors, these do still occur. If you discover
230 an error in this manual or if you want to give any
231 comments, suggestions, or criticisms please send an email to
232 the Debian Policy List,
233 <email>debian-policy@lists.debian.org</email>, or submit a
234 bug report against the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
238 Please do not try to reach the individual authors or maintainers
239 of the Policy Manual regarding changes to the Policy.
244 <heading>Related documents</heading>
247 There are several other documents other than this Policy Manual
248 that are necessary to fully understand some Debian policies and
253 The external "sub-policy" documents are referred to in:
254 <list compact="compact">
255 <item><ref id="fhs"></item>
256 <item><ref id="virtual_pkg"></item>
257 <item><ref id="menus"></item>
258 <item><ref id="mime"></item>
259 <item><ref id="perl"></item>
260 <item><ref id="maintscriptprompt"></item>
261 <item><ref id="emacs"></item>
266 In addition to those, which carry the weight of policy, there
267 is the Debian Developer's Reference. This document describes
268 procedures and resources for Debian developers, but it is
269 <em>not</em> normative; rather, it includes things that don't
270 belong in the Policy, such as best practices for developers.
274 The Developer's Reference is available in the
275 <package>developers-reference</package> package.
276 It's also available from the Debian web mirrors at
277 <tt><url name="/doc/developers-reference/"
278 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/developers-reference/"></tt>.
282 <sect id="definitions">
283 <heading>Definitions</heading>
286 The following terms are used in this Policy Manual:
290 The character encoding specified by ANSI X3.4-1986 and its
291 predecessor standards, referred to in MIME as US-ASCII, and
292 corresponding to an encoding in eight bits per character of
293 the first 128 <url id="http://www.unicode.org/"
294 name="Unicode"> characters, with the eighth bit always zero.
298 The transformation format (sometimes called encoding) of
299 <url id="http://www.unicode.org/" name="Unicode"> defined by
300 <url id="http://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3629.txt"
301 name="RFC 3629">. UTF-8 has the useful property of having
302 ASCII as a subset, so any text encoded in ASCII is trivially
312 <heading>The Debian Archive</heading>
315 The Debian GNU/Linux system is maintained and distributed as a
316 collection of <em>packages</em>. Since there are so many of
317 them (currently well over 15000), they are split into
318 <em>sections</em> and given <em>priorities</em> to simplify
319 the handling of them.
323 The effort of the Debian project is to build a free operating
324 system, but not every package we want to make accessible is
325 <em>free</em> in our sense (see the Debian Free Software
326 Guidelines, below), or may be imported/exported without
327 restrictions. Thus, the archive is split into areas<footnote>
328 The Debian archive software uses the term "component" internally
329 and in the Release file format to refer to the division of an
330 archive. The Debian Social Contract simply refers to "areas."
331 This document uses terminology similar to the Social Contract.
332 </footnote> based on their licenses and other restrictions.
336 The aims of this are:
338 <list compact="compact">
339 <item>to allow us to make as much software available as we can</item>
340 <item>to allow us to encourage everyone to write free software,
342 <item>to allow us to make it easy for people to produce
343 CD-ROMs of our system without violating any licenses,
344 import/export restrictions, or any other laws.</item>
349 The <em>main</em> archive area forms the <em>Debian GNU/Linux
354 Packages in the other archive areas (<tt>contrib</tt>,
355 <tt>non-free</tt>) are not considered to be part of the Debian
356 distribution, although we support their use and provide
357 infrastructure for them (such as our bug-tracking system and
358 mailing lists). This Debian Policy Manual applies to these
363 <heading>The Debian Free Software Guidelines</heading>
365 The Debian Free Software Guidelines (DFSG) form our
366 definition of "free software". These are:
368 <tag>1. Free Redistribution
371 The license of a Debian component may not restrict any
372 party from selling or giving away the software as a
373 component of an aggregate software distribution
374 containing programs from several different
375 sources. The license may not require a royalty or
376 other fee for such sale.
381 The program must include source code, and must allow
382 distribution in source code as well as compiled form.
384 <tag>3. Derived Works
387 The license must allow modifications and derived
388 works, and must allow them to be distributed under the
389 same terms as the license of the original software.
391 <tag>4. Integrity of The Author's Source Code
394 The license may restrict source-code from being
395 distributed in modified form <em>only</em> if the
396 license allows the distribution of "patch files"
397 with the source code for the purpose of modifying the
398 program at build time. The license must explicitly
399 permit distribution of software built from modified
400 source code. The license may require derived works to
401 carry a different name or version number from the
402 original software. (This is a compromise. The Debian
403 Project encourages all authors to not restrict any
404 files, source or binary, from being modified.)
406 <tag>5. No Discrimination Against Persons or Groups
409 The license must not discriminate against any person
412 <tag>6. No Discrimination Against Fields of Endeavor
415 The license must not restrict anyone from making use
416 of the program in a specific field of endeavor. For
417 example, it may not restrict the program from being
418 used in a business, or from being used for genetic
421 <tag>7. Distribution of License
424 The rights attached to the program must apply to all
425 to whom the program is redistributed without the need
426 for execution of an additional license by those
429 <tag>8. License Must Not Be Specific to Debian
432 The rights attached to the program must not depend on
433 the program's being part of a Debian system. If the
434 program is extracted from Debian and used or
435 distributed without Debian but otherwise within the
436 terms of the program's license, all parties to whom
437 the program is redistributed must have the same
438 rights as those that are granted in conjunction with
441 <tag>9. License Must Not Contaminate Other Software
444 The license must not place restrictions on other
445 software that is distributed along with the licensed
446 software. For example, the license must not insist
447 that all other programs distributed on the same medium
448 must be free software.
450 <tag>10. Example Licenses
453 The "GPL," "BSD," and "Artistic" licenses are examples of
454 licenses that we consider <em>free</em>.
461 <heading>Archive areas</heading>
464 <heading>The main archive area</heading>
467 Every package in <em>main</em> must comply with the DFSG
468 (Debian Free Software Guidelines).
472 In addition, the packages in <em>main</em>
473 <list compact="compact">
475 must not require a package outside of <em>main</em>
476 for compilation or execution (thus, the package must
477 not declare a "Depends", "Recommends", or
478 "Build-Depends" relationship on a non-<em>main</em>
482 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
486 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
495 <heading>The contrib archive area</heading>
498 Every package in <em>contrib</em> must comply with the DFSG.
502 In addition, the packages in <em>contrib</em>
503 <list compact="compact">
505 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
509 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
517 Examples of packages which would be included in
518 <em>contrib</em> are:
519 <list compact="compact">
521 free packages which require <em>contrib</em>,
522 <em>non-free</em> packages or packages which are not
523 in our archive at all for compilation or execution,
527 wrapper packages or other sorts of free accessories for
534 <sect1 id="non-free">
535 <heading>The non-free archive area</heading>
538 Packages must be placed in <em>non-free</em> if they are
539 not compliant with the DFSG or are encumbered by patents
540 or other legal issues that make their distribution
545 In addition, the packages in <em>non-free</em>
546 <list compact="compact">
548 must not be so buggy that we refuse to support them,
552 must meet all policy requirements presented in this
553 manual that it is possible for them to meet.
555 It is possible that there are policy
556 requirements which the package is unable to
557 meet, for example, if the source is
558 unavailable. These situations will need to be
559 handled on a case-by-case basis.
568 <sect id="pkgcopyright">
569 <heading>Copyright considerations</heading>
572 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its
573 copyright information and distribution license in the file
574 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>
575 (see <ref id="copyrightfile"> for further details).
579 We reserve the right to restrict files from being included
580 anywhere in our archives if
581 <list compact="compact">
583 their use or distribution would break a law,
586 there is an ethical conflict in their distribution or
590 we would have to sign a license for them, or
593 their distribution would conflict with other project
600 Programs whose authors encourage the user to make
601 donations are fine for the main distribution, provided
602 that the authors do not claim that not donating is
603 immoral, unethical, illegal or something similar; in such
604 a case they must go in <em>non-free</em>.
608 Packages whose copyright permission notices (or patent
609 problems) do not even allow redistribution of binaries
610 only, and where no special permission has been obtained,
611 must not be placed on the Debian FTP site and its mirrors
616 Note that under international copyright law (this applies
617 in the United States, too), <em>no</em> distribution or
618 modification of a work is allowed without an explicit
619 notice saying so. Therefore a program without a copyright
620 notice <em>is</em> copyrighted and you may not do anything
621 to it without risking being sued! Likewise if a program
622 has a copyright notice but no statement saying what is
623 permitted then nothing is permitted.
627 Many authors are unaware of the problems that restrictive
628 copyrights (or lack of copyright notices) can cause for
629 the users of their supposedly-free software. It is often
630 worthwhile contacting such authors diplomatically to ask
631 them to modify their license terms. However, this can be a
632 politically difficult thing to do and you should ask for
633 advice on the <tt>debian-legal</tt> mailing list first, as
638 When in doubt about a copyright, send mail to
639 <email>debian-legal@lists.debian.org</email>. Be prepared
640 to provide us with the copyright statement. Software
641 covered by the GPL, public domain software and BSD-like
642 copyrights are safe; be wary of the phrases "commercial
643 use prohibited" and "distribution restricted".
647 <sect id="subsections">
648 <heading>Sections</heading>
651 The packages in the archive areas <em>main</em>,
652 <em>contrib</em> and <em>non-free</em> are grouped further into
653 <em>sections</em> to simplify handling.
657 The archive area and section for each package should be
658 specified in the package's <tt>Section</tt> control record (see
659 <ref id="f-Section">). However, the maintainer of the Debian
660 archive may override this selection to ensure the consistency of
661 the Debian distribution. The <tt>Section</tt> field should be
663 <list compact="compact">
665 <em>section</em> if the package is in the
666 <em>main</em> archive area,
669 <em>area/section</em> if the package is in
670 the <em>contrib</em> or <em>non-free</em>
677 The Debian archive maintainers provide the authoritative
678 list of sections. At present, they are:
679 <em>admin</em>, <em>cli-mono</em>, <em>comm</em>, <em>database</em>,
680 <em>devel</em>, <em>debug</em>, <em>doc</em>, <em>editors</em>,
681 <em>electronics</em>, <em>embedded</em>, <em>fonts</em>,
682 <em>games</em>, <em>gnome</em>, <em>graphics</em>, <em>gnu-r</em>,
683 <em>gnustep</em>, <em>hamradio</em>, <em>haskell</em>,
684 <em>httpd</em>, <em>interpreters</em>, <em>java</em>, <em>kde</em>,
685 <em>kernel</em>, <em>libs</em>, <em>libdevel</em>, <em>lisp</em>,
686 <em>localization</em>, <em>mail</em>, <em>math</em>, <em>misc</em>,
687 <em>net</em>, <em>news</em>, <em>ocaml</em>, <em>oldlibs</em>,
688 <em>otherosfs</em>, <em>perl</em>, <em>php</em>, <em>python</em>,
689 <em>ruby</em>, <em>science</em>, <em>shells</em>, <em>sound</em>,
690 <em>tex</em>, <em>text</em>, <em>utils</em>, <em>vcs</em>,
691 <em>video</em>, <em>web</em>, <em>x11</em>, <em>xfce</em>,
692 <em>zope</em>. The additional section <em>debian-installer</em>
693 contains special packages used by the installer and is not used
694 for normal Debian packages.
698 For more information about the sections and their definitions,
699 see the <url id="http://packages.debian.org/unstable/"
700 name="list of sections in unstable">.
704 <sect id="priorities">
705 <heading>Priorities</heading>
708 Each package should have a <em>priority</em> value, which is
709 included in the package's <em>control record</em>
710 (see <ref id="f-Priority">).
711 This information is used by the Debian package management tools to
712 separate high-priority packages from less-important packages.
716 The following <em>priority levels</em> are recognized by the
717 Debian package management tools.
719 <tag><tt>required</tt></tag>
721 Packages which are necessary for the proper
722 functioning of the system (usually, this means that
723 dpkg functionality depends on these packages).
724 Removing a <tt>required</tt> package may cause your
725 system to become totally broken and you may not even
726 be able to use <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to put things back,
727 so only do so if you know what you are doing. Systems
728 with only the <tt>required</tt> packages are probably
729 unusable, but they do have enough functionality to
730 allow the sysadmin to boot and install more software.
732 <tag><tt>important</tt></tag>
734 Important programs, including those which one would
735 expect to find on any Unix-like system. If the
736 expectation is that an experienced Unix person who
737 found it missing would say "What on earth is going on,
738 where is <prgn>foo</prgn>?", it must be an
739 <tt>important</tt> package.<footnote>
740 This is an important criterion because we are
741 trying to produce, amongst other things, a free
744 Other packages without which the system will not run
745 well or be usable must also have priority
746 <tt>important</tt>. This does
747 <em>not</em> include Emacs, the X Window System, TeX
748 or any other large applications. The
749 <tt>important</tt> packages are just a bare minimum of
750 commonly-expected and necessary tools.
752 <tag><tt>standard</tt></tag>
754 These packages provide a reasonably small but not too
755 limited character-mode system. This is what will be
756 installed by default if the user doesn't select anything
757 else. It doesn't include many large applications.
759 <tag><tt>optional</tt></tag>
761 (In a sense everything that isn't required is
762 optional, but that's not what is meant here.) This is
763 all the software that you might reasonably want to
764 install if you didn't know what it was and don't have
765 specialized requirements. This is a much larger system
766 and includes the X Window System, a full TeX
767 distribution, and many applications. Note that
768 optional packages should not conflict with each other.
770 <tag><tt>extra</tt></tag>
772 This contains all packages that conflict with others
773 with required, important, standard or optional
774 priorities, or are only likely to be useful if you
775 already know what they are or have specialized
776 requirements (such as packages containing only detached
783 Packages must not depend on packages with lower priority
784 values (excluding build-time dependencies). In order to
785 ensure this, the priorities of one or more packages may need
794 <heading>Binary packages</heading>
797 The Debian GNU/Linux distribution is based on the Debian
798 package management system, called <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. Thus,
799 all packages in the Debian distribution must be provided
800 in the <tt>.deb</tt> file format.
804 <heading>The package name</heading>
807 Every package must have a name that's unique within the Debian
812 The package name is included in the control field
813 <tt>Package</tt>, the format of which is described
814 in <ref id="f-Package">.
815 The package name is also included as a part of the file name
816 of the <tt>.deb</tt> file.
821 <heading>The version of a package</heading>
824 Every package has a version number recorded in its
825 <tt>Version</tt> control file field, described in
826 <ref id="f-Version">.
830 The package management system imposes an ordering on version
831 numbers, so that it can tell whether packages are being up- or
832 downgraded and so that package system front end applications
833 can tell whether a package it finds available is newer than
834 the one installed on the system. The version number format
835 has the most significant parts (as far as comparison is
836 concerned) at the beginning.
840 If an upstream package has problematic version numbers they
841 should be converted to a sane form for use in the
842 <tt>Version</tt> field.
846 <heading>Version numbers based on dates</heading>
849 In general, Debian packages should use the same version
850 numbers as the upstream sources.
854 However, in some cases where the upstream version number is
855 based on a date (e.g., a development "snapshot" release) the
856 package management system cannot handle these version
857 numbers without epochs. For example, dpkg will consider
858 "96May01" to be greater than "96Dec24".
862 To prevent having to use epochs for every new upstream
863 version, the date based portion of the version number
864 should be changed to the following format in such cases:
865 "19960501", "19961224". It is up to the maintainer whether
866 they want to bother the upstream maintainer to change
867 the version numbers upstream, too.
871 Note that other version formats based on dates which are
872 parsed correctly by the package management system should
873 <em>not</em> be changed.
877 Native Debian packages (i.e., packages which have been
878 written especially for Debian) whose version numbers include
879 dates should always use the "YYYYMMDD" format.
886 <heading>The maintainer of a package</heading>
889 Every package must have a Debian maintainer (the
890 maintainer may be one person or a group of people
891 reachable from a common email address, such as a mailing
892 list). The maintainer is responsible for ensuring that
893 the package is placed in the appropriate distributions.
897 The maintainer must be specified in the
898 <tt>Maintainer</tt> control field with their correct name
899 and a working email address. If one person maintains
900 several packages, they should try to avoid having
901 different forms of their name and email address in
902 the <tt>Maintainer</tt> fields of those packages.
906 The format of the <tt>Maintainer</tt> control field is
907 described in <ref id="f-Maintainer">.
911 If the maintainer of a package quits from the Debian
912 project, "Debian QA Group"
913 <email>packages@qa.debian.org</email> takes over the
914 maintainer-ship of the package until someone else
915 volunteers for that task. These packages are called
916 <em>orphaned packages</em>.<footnote>
917 The detailed procedure for doing this gracefully can
918 be found in the Debian Developer's Reference,
919 see <ref id="related">.
924 <sect id="descriptions">
925 <heading>The description of a package</heading>
928 Every Debian package must have an extended description
929 stored in the appropriate field of the control record.
930 The technical information about the format of the
931 <tt>Description</tt> field is in <ref id="f-Description">.
935 The description should describe the package (the program) to a
936 user (system administrator) who has never met it before so that
937 they have enough information to decide whether they want to
938 install it. This description should not just be copied verbatim
939 from the program's documentation.
943 Put important information first, both in the synopsis and
944 extended description. Sometimes only the first part of the
945 synopsis or of the description will be displayed. You can
946 assume that there will usually be a way to see the whole
947 extended description.
951 The description should also give information about the
952 significant dependencies and conflicts between this package
953 and others, so that the user knows why these dependencies and
954 conflicts have been declared.
958 Instructions for configuring or using the package should
959 not be included (that is what installation scripts,
960 manual pages, info files, etc., are for). Copyright
961 statements and other administrivia should not be included
962 either (that is what the copyright file is for).
965 <sect1 id="synopsis"><heading>The single line synopsis</heading>
968 The single line synopsis should be kept brief - certainly
973 Do not include the package name in the synopsis line. The
974 display software knows how to display this already, and you
975 do not need to state it. Remember that in many situations
976 the user may only see the synopsis line - make it as
977 informative as you can.
982 <sect1 id="extendeddesc"><heading>The extended description</heading>
985 Do not try to continue the single line synopsis into the
986 extended description. This will not work correctly when
987 the full description is displayed, and makes no sense
988 where only the summary (the single line synopsis) is
993 The extended description should describe what the package
994 does and how it relates to the rest of the system (in terms
995 of, for example, which subsystem it is which part of).
999 The description field needs to make sense to anyone, even
1000 people who have no idea about any of the things the
1001 package deals with.<footnote>
1002 The blurb that comes with a program in its
1003 announcements and/or <prgn>README</prgn> files is
1004 rarely suitable for use in a description. It is
1005 usually aimed at people who are already in the
1006 community where the package is used.
1015 <heading>Dependencies</heading>
1018 Every package must specify the dependency information
1019 about other packages that are required for the first to
1024 For example, a dependency entry must be provided for any
1025 shared libraries required by a dynamically-linked executable
1026 binary in a package.
1030 Packages are not required to declare any dependencies they
1031 have on other packages which are marked <tt>Essential</tt>
1032 (see below), and should not do so unless they depend on a
1033 particular version of that package.<footnote>
1035 Essential is needed in part to avoid unresolvable dependency
1036 loops on upgrade. If packages add unnecessary dependencies
1037 on packages in this set, the chances that there
1038 <strong>will</strong> be an unresolvable dependency loop
1039 caused by forcing these Essential packages to be configured
1040 first before they need to be is greatly increased. It also
1041 increases the chances that frontends will be unable to
1042 <strong>calculate</strong> an upgrade path, even if one
1046 Also, functionality is rarely ever removed from the
1047 Essential set, but <em>packages</em> have been removed from
1048 the Essential set when the functionality moved to a
1049 different package. So depending on these packages <em>just
1050 in case</em> they stop being essential does way more harm
1057 Sometimes, a package requires another package to be installed
1058 <em>and</em> configured before it can be installed. In this
1059 case, you must specify a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> entry for
1064 You should not specify a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> entry for a
1065 package before this has been discussed on the
1066 <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list and a consensus about
1067 doing that has been reached.
1071 The format of the package interrelationship control fields is
1072 described in <ref id="relationships">.
1076 <sect id="virtual_pkg">
1077 <heading>Virtual packages</heading>
1080 Sometimes, there are several packages which offer
1081 more-or-less the same functionality. In this case, it's
1082 useful to define a <em>virtual package</em> whose name
1083 describes that common functionality. (The virtual
1084 packages only exist logically, not physically; that's why
1085 they are called <em>virtual</em>.) The packages with this
1086 particular function will then <em>provide</em> the virtual
1087 package. Thus, any other package requiring that function
1088 can simply depend on the virtual package without having to
1089 specify all possible packages individually.
1093 All packages should use virtual package names where
1094 appropriate, and arrange to create new ones if necessary.
1095 They should not use virtual package names (except privately,
1096 amongst a cooperating group of packages) unless they have
1097 been agreed upon and appear in the list of virtual package
1098 names. (See also <ref id="virtual">)
1102 The latest version of the authoritative list of virtual
1103 package names can be found in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
1104 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
1105 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/virtual-package-names-list.txt"
1106 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/virtual-package-names-list.txt"></tt>.
1110 The procedure for updating the list is described in the preface
1117 <heading>Base system</heading>
1120 The <tt>base system</tt> is a minimum subset of the Debian
1121 GNU/Linux system that is installed before everything else
1122 on a new system. Only very few packages are allowed to form
1123 part of the base system, in order to keep the required disk
1128 The base system consists of all those packages with priority
1129 <tt>required</tt> or <tt>important</tt>. Many of them will
1130 be tagged <tt>essential</tt> (see below).
1135 <heading>Essential packages</heading>
1138 Essential is defined as the minimal set of functionality that
1139 must be available and usable on the system at all times, even
1140 when packages are in an unconfigured (but unpacked) state.
1141 Packages are tagged <tt>essential</tt> for a system using the
1142 <tt>Essential</tt> control file field. The format of the
1143 <tt>Essential</tt> control field is described in <ref
1148 Since these packages cannot be easily removed (one has to
1149 specify an extra <em>force option</em> to
1150 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to do so), this flag must not be used
1151 unless absolutely necessary. A shared library package
1152 must not be tagged <tt>essential</tt>; dependencies will
1153 prevent its premature removal, and we need to be able to
1154 remove it when it has been superseded.
1158 Since dpkg will not prevent upgrading of other packages
1159 while an <tt>essential</tt> package is in an unconfigured
1160 state, all <tt>essential</tt> packages must supply all of
1161 their core functionality even when unconfigured. If the
1162 package cannot satisfy this requirement it must not be
1163 tagged as essential, and any packages depending on this
1164 package must instead have explicit dependency fields as
1169 Maintainers should take great care in adding any programs,
1170 interfaces, or functionality to <tt>essential</tt> packages.
1171 Packages may assume that functionality provided by
1172 <tt>essential</tt> packages is always available without
1173 declaring explicit dependencies, which means that removing
1174 functionality from the Essential set is very difficult and is
1175 almost never done. Any capability added to an
1176 <tt>essential</tt> package therefore creates an obligation to
1177 support that capability as part of the Essential set in
1182 You must not tag any packages <tt>essential</tt> before
1183 this has been discussed on the <tt>debian-devel</tt>
1184 mailing list and a consensus about doing that has been
1189 <sect id="maintscripts">
1190 <heading>Maintainer Scripts</heading>
1193 The package installation scripts should avoid producing
1194 output which is unnecessary for the user to see and
1195 should rely on <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to stave off boredom on
1196 the part of a user installing many packages. This means,
1197 amongst other things, using the <tt>--quiet</tt> option on
1198 <prgn>install-info</prgn>.
1202 Errors which occur during the execution of an installation
1203 script must be checked and the installation must not
1204 continue after an error.
1208 Note that in general <ref id="scripts"> applies to package
1209 maintainer scripts, too.
1213 You should not use <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> on a file
1214 belonging to another package without consulting the
1215 maintainer of that package first.
1219 All packages which supply an instance of a common command
1220 name (or, in general, filename) should generally use
1221 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>, so that they may be
1222 installed together. If <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>
1223 is not used, then each package must use
1224 <tt>Conflicts</tt> to ensure that other packages are
1225 de-installed. (In this case, it may be appropriate to
1226 specify a conflict against earlier versions of something
1227 that previously did not use
1228 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>; this is an exception to
1229 the usual rule that versioned conflicts should be
1233 <sect1 id="maintscriptprompt">
1234 <heading>Prompting in maintainer scripts</heading>
1236 Package maintainer scripts may prompt the user if
1237 necessary. Prompting must be done by communicating
1238 through a program, such as <prgn>debconf</prgn>, which
1239 conforms to the Debian Configuration Management
1240 Specification, version 2 or higher.
1244 Packages which are essential, or which are dependencies of
1245 essential packages, may fall back on another prompting method
1246 if no such interface is available when they are executed.
1250 The Debian Configuration Management Specification is included
1251 in the <file>debconf_specification</file> files in the
1252 <package>debian-policy</package> package.
1253 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
1254 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/debconf_specification.html"
1255 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/debconf_specification.html"></tt>.
1259 Packages which use the Debian Configuration Management
1260 Specification may contain an additional
1261 <prgn>config</prgn> script and a <tt>templates</tt>
1262 file in their control archive<footnote>
1263 The control.tar.gz inside the .deb.
1264 See <manref name="deb" section="5">.
1266 The <prgn>config</prgn> script might be run before the
1267 <prgn>preinst</prgn> script, and before the package is unpacked
1268 or any of its dependencies or pre-dependencies are satisfied.
1269 Therefore it must work using only the tools present in
1270 <em>essential</em> packages.<footnote>
1271 <package>Debconf</package> or another tool that
1272 implements the Debian Configuration Management
1273 Specification will also be installed, and any
1274 versioned dependencies on it will be satisfied
1275 before preconfiguration begins.
1280 Packages which use the Debian Configuration Management
1281 Specification must allow for translation of their user-visible
1282 messages by using a gettext-based system such as the one
1283 provided by the <package>po-debconf</package> package.
1287 Packages should try to minimize the amount of prompting
1288 they need to do, and they should ensure that the user
1289 will only ever be asked each question once. This means
1290 that packages should try to use appropriate shared
1291 configuration files (such as <file>/etc/papersize</file> and
1292 <file>/etc/news/server</file>), and shared
1293 <package>debconf</package> variables rather than each
1294 prompting for their own list of required pieces of
1299 It also means that an upgrade should not ask the same
1300 questions again, unless the user has used
1301 <tt>dpkg --purge</tt> to remove the package's configuration.
1302 The answers to configuration questions should be stored in an
1303 appropriate place in <file>/etc</file> so that the user can
1304 modify them, and how this has been done should be
1309 If a package has a vitally important piece of
1310 information to pass to the user (such as "don't run me
1311 as I am, you must edit the following configuration files
1312 first or you risk your system emitting badly-formatted
1313 messages"), it should display this in the
1314 <prgn>config</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn> script and
1315 prompt the user to hit return to acknowledge the
1316 message. Copyright messages do not count as vitally
1317 important (they belong in
1318 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>);
1319 neither do instructions on how to use a program (these
1320 should be in on-line documentation, where all the users
1325 Any necessary prompting should almost always be confined
1326 to the <prgn>config</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn>
1327 script. If it is done in the <prgn>postinst</prgn>, it
1328 should be protected with a conditional so that
1329 unnecessary prompting doesn't happen if a package's
1330 installation fails and the <prgn>postinst</prgn> is
1331 called with <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>,
1332 <tt>abort-remove</tt> or <tt>abort-deconfigure</tt>.
1342 <heading>Source packages</heading>
1344 <sect id="standardsversion">
1345 <heading>Standards conformance</heading>
1348 Source packages should specify the most recent version number
1349 of this policy document with which your package complied
1350 when it was last updated.
1354 This information may be used to file bug reports
1355 automatically if your package becomes too much out of date.
1359 The version is specified in the <tt>Standards-Version</tt>
1361 The format of the <tt>Standards-Version</tt> field is
1362 described in <ref id="f-Standards-Version">.
1366 You should regularly, and especially if your package has
1367 become out of date, check for the newest Policy Manual
1368 available and update your package, if necessary. When your
1369 package complies with the new standards you should update the
1370 <tt>Standards-Version</tt> source package field and
1371 release it.<footnote>
1372 See the file <file>upgrading-checklist</file> for
1373 information about policy which has changed between
1374 different versions of this document.
1380 <sect id="pkg-relations">
1381 <heading>Package relationships</heading>
1384 Source packages should specify which binary packages they
1385 require to be installed or not to be installed in order to
1386 build correctly. For example, if building a package
1387 requires a certain compiler, then the compiler should be
1388 specified as a build-time dependency.
1392 It is not necessary to explicitly specify build-time
1393 relationships on a minimal set of packages that are always
1394 needed to compile, link and put in a Debian package a
1395 standard "Hello World!" program written in C or C++. The
1396 required packages are called <em>build-essential</em>, and
1397 an informational list can be found in
1398 <file>/usr/share/doc/build-essential/list</file> (which is
1399 contained in the <tt>build-essential</tt>
1402 <list compact="compact">
1404 This allows maintaining the list separately
1405 from the policy documents (the list does not
1406 need the kind of control that the policy
1410 Having a separate package allows one to install
1411 the build-essential packages on a machine, as
1412 well as allowing other packages such as tasks to
1413 require installation of the build-essential
1414 packages using the depends relation.
1417 The separate package allows bug reports against
1418 the list to be categorized separately from
1419 the policy management process in the BTS.
1426 When specifying the set of build-time dependencies, one
1427 should list only those packages explicitly required by the
1428 build. It is not necessary to list packages which are
1429 required merely because some other package in the list of
1430 build-time dependencies depends on them.<footnote>
1431 The reason for this is that dependencies change, and
1432 you should list all those packages, and <em>only</em>
1433 those packages that <em>you</em> need directly. What
1434 others need is their business. For example, if you
1435 only link against <file>libimlib</file>, you will need to
1436 build-depend on <package>libimlib2-dev</package> but
1437 not against any <tt>libjpeg*</tt> packages, even
1438 though <tt>libimlib2-dev</tt> currently depends on
1439 them: installation of <package>libimlib2-dev</package>
1440 will automatically ensure that all of its run-time
1441 dependencies are satisfied.
1446 If build-time dependencies are specified, it must be
1447 possible to build the package and produce working binaries
1448 on a system with only essential and build-essential
1449 packages installed and also those required to satisfy the
1450 build-time relationships (including any implied
1451 relationships). In particular, this means that version
1452 clauses should be used rigorously in build-time
1453 relationships so that one cannot produce bad or
1454 inconsistently configured packages when the relationships
1455 are properly satisfied.
1459 <ref id="relationships"> explains the technical details.
1464 <heading>Changes to the upstream sources</heading>
1467 If changes to the source code are made that are not
1468 specific to the needs of the Debian system, they should be
1469 sent to the upstream authors in whatever form they prefer
1470 so as to be included in the upstream version of the
1475 If you need to configure the package differently for
1476 Debian or for Linux, and the upstream source doesn't
1477 provide a way to do so, you should add such configuration
1478 facilities (for example, a new <prgn>autoconf</prgn> test
1479 or <tt>#define</tt>) and send the patch to the upstream
1480 authors, with the default set to the way they originally
1481 had it. You can then easily override the default in your
1482 <file>debian/rules</file> or wherever is appropriate.
1486 You should make sure that the <prgn>configure</prgn> utility
1487 detects the correct architecture specification string
1488 (refer to <ref id="arch-spec"> for details).
1492 If you need to edit a <prgn>Makefile</prgn> where GNU-style
1493 <prgn>configure</prgn> scripts are used, you should edit the
1494 <file>.in</file> files rather than editing the
1495 <prgn>Makefile</prgn> directly. This allows the user to
1496 reconfigure the package if necessary. You should
1497 <em>not</em> configure the package and edit the generated
1498 <prgn>Makefile</prgn>! This makes it impossible for someone
1499 else to later reconfigure the package without losing the
1505 <sect id="dpkgchangelog">
1506 <heading>Debian changelog: <file>debian/changelog</file></heading>
1509 Changes in the Debian version of the package should be
1510 briefly explained in the Debian changelog file
1511 <file>debian/changelog</file>.<footnote>
1513 Mistakes in changelogs are usually best rectified by
1514 making a new changelog entry rather than "rewriting
1515 history" by editing old changelog entries.
1518 This includes modifications
1519 made in the Debian package compared to the upstream one
1520 as well as other changes and updates to the package.
1522 Although there is nothing stopping an author who is also
1523 the Debian maintainer from using this changelog for all
1524 their changes, it will have to be renamed if the Debian
1525 and upstream maintainers become different people. In such
1526 a case, however, it might be better to maintain the package
1527 as a non-native package.
1532 The format of the <file>debian/changelog</file> allows the
1533 package building tools to discover which version of the package
1534 is being built and find out other release-specific information.
1538 That format is a series of entries like this:
1540 <example compact="compact">
1541 <var>package</var> (<var>version</var>) <var>distribution(s)</var>; urgency=<var>urgency</var>
1543 [optional blank line(s), stripped]
1545 * <var>change details</var>
1546 <var>more change details</var>
1548 [blank line(s), included in output of dpkg-parsechangelog]
1550 * <var>even more change details</var>
1552 [optional blank line(s), stripped]
1554 -- <var>maintainer name</var> <<var>email address</var>><var>[two spaces]</var> <var>date</var>
1559 <var>package</var> and <var>version</var> are the source
1560 package name and version number.
1564 <var>distribution(s)</var> lists the distributions where
1565 this version should be installed when it is uploaded - it
1566 is copied to the <tt>Distribution</tt> field in the
1567 <file>.changes</file> file. See <ref id="f-Distribution">.
1571 <var>urgency</var> is the value for the <tt>Urgency</tt>
1572 field in the <file>.changes</file> file for the upload
1573 (see <ref id="f-Urgency">). It is not possible to specify
1574 an urgency containing commas; commas are used to separate
1575 <tt><var>keyword</var>=<var>value</var></tt> settings in the
1576 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> changelog format (though there is
1577 currently only one useful <var>keyword</var>,
1582 The change details may in fact be any series of lines
1583 starting with at least two spaces, but conventionally each
1584 change starts with an asterisk and a separating space and
1585 continuation lines are indented so as to bring them in
1586 line with the start of the text above. Blank lines may be
1587 used here to separate groups of changes, if desired.
1591 If this upload resolves bugs recorded in the Bug Tracking
1592 System (BTS), they may be automatically closed on the
1593 inclusion of this package into the Debian archive by
1594 including the string: <tt>closes: Bug#<var>nnnnn</var></tt>
1595 in the change details.<footnote>
1596 To be precise, the string should match the following
1597 Perl regular expression:
1599 /closes:\s*(?:bug)?\#?\s?\d+(?:,\s*(?:bug)?\#?\s?\d+)*/i
1601 Then all of the bug numbers listed will be closed by the
1602 archive maintenance script (<prgn>katie</prgn>) using the
1603 <var>version</var> of the changelog entry.
1605 This information is conveyed via the <tt>Closes</tt> field
1606 in the <tt>.changes</tt> file (see <ref id="f-Closes">).
1610 The maintainer name and email address used in the changelog
1611 should be the details of the person uploading <em>this</em>
1612 version. They are <em>not</em> necessarily those of the
1613 usual package maintainer. The information here will be
1614 copied to the <tt>Changed-By</tt> field in the
1615 <tt>.changes</tt> file (see <ref id="f-Changed-By">),
1616 and then later used to send an acknowledgement when the
1617 upload has been installed.
1621 The <var>date</var> has the following format<footnote>
1622 This is the same as the format generated by <tt>date
1624 </footnote> (compatible and with the same semantics of
1625 RFC 2822 and RFC 5322):
1626 <example>day-of-week, dd month yyyy hh:mm:ss +zzzz</example>
1628 <list compact="compact">
1630 day-of week is one of: Mon, Tue, Wed, Thu, Fri, Sat, Sun
1633 dd is a one- or two-digit day of the month (01-31)
1636 month is one of: Jan, Feb, Mar, Apr, May, Jun, Jul, Aug,
1639 <item>yyyy is the four-digit year (e.g. 2010)</item>
1640 <item>hh is the two-digit hour (00-23)</item>
1641 <item>mm is the two-digit minutes (00-59)</item>
1642 <item>ss is the two-digit seconds (00-60)</item>
1644 +zzzz or -zzzz is the the time zone offset from Coordinated
1645 Universal Time (UTC). "+" indicates that the time is ahead
1646 of (i.e., east of) UTC and "-" indicates that the time is
1647 behind (i.e., west of) UTC. The first two digits indicate
1648 the hour difference from UTC and the last two digits
1649 indicate the number of additional minutes difference from
1650 UTC. The last two digits must be in the range 00-59.
1656 The first "title" line with the package name must start
1657 at the left hand margin. The "trailer" line with the
1658 maintainer and date details must be preceded by exactly
1659 one space. The maintainer details and the date must be
1660 separated by exactly two spaces.
1664 The entire changelog must be encoded in UTF-8.
1668 For more information on placement of the changelog files
1669 within binary packages, please see <ref id="changelogs">.
1673 <sect id="dpkgcopyright">
1674 <heading>Copyright: <file>debian/copyright</file></heading>
1676 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its
1677 copyright information and distribution license in the file
1678 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>
1679 (see <ref id="copyrightfile"> for further details). Also see
1680 <ref id="pkgcopyright"> for further considerations related
1681 to copyrights for packages.
1685 <heading>Error trapping in makefiles</heading>
1688 When <prgn>make</prgn> invokes a command in a makefile
1689 (including your package's upstream makefiles and
1690 <file>debian/rules</file>), it does so using <prgn>sh</prgn>. This
1691 means that <prgn>sh</prgn>'s usual bad error handling
1692 properties apply: if you include a miniature script as one
1693 of the commands in your makefile you'll find that if you
1694 don't do anything about it then errors are not detected
1695 and <prgn>make</prgn> will blithely continue after
1700 Every time you put more than one shell command (this
1701 includes using a loop) in a makefile command you
1702 must make sure that errors are trapped. For
1703 simple compound commands, such as changing directory and
1704 then running a program, using <tt>&&</tt> rather
1705 than semicolon as a command separator is sufficient. For
1706 more complex commands including most loops and
1707 conditionals you should include a separate <tt>set -e</tt>
1708 command at the start of every makefile command that's
1709 actually one of these miniature shell scripts.
1713 <sect id="timestamps">
1714 <heading>Time Stamps</heading>
1716 Maintainers should preserve the modification times of the
1717 upstream source files in a package, as far as is reasonably
1719 The rationale is that there is some information conveyed
1720 by knowing the age of the file, for example, you could
1721 recognize that some documentation is very old by looking
1722 at the modification time, so it would be nice if the
1723 modification time of the upstream source would be
1729 <sect id="restrictions">
1730 <heading>Restrictions on objects in source packages</heading>
1733 The source package may not contain any hard links<footnote>
1735 This is not currently detected when building source
1736 packages, but only when extracting
1740 Hard links may be permitted at some point in the
1741 future, but would require a fair amount of
1744 </footnote>, device special files, sockets or setuid or
1745 setgid files.<footnote>
1746 Setgid directories are allowed.
1751 <sect id="debianrules">
1752 <heading>Main building script: <file>debian/rules</file></heading>
1755 This file must be an executable makefile, and contains the
1756 package-specific recipes for compiling the package and
1757 building binary package(s) from the source.
1761 It must start with the line <tt>#!/usr/bin/make -f</tt>,
1762 so that it can be invoked by saying its name rather than
1763 invoking <prgn>make</prgn> explicitly. That is, invoking
1764 either of <tt>make -f debian/rules <em>args...</em></tt>
1765 or <tt>./debian/rules <em>args...</em></tt> must result in
1770 Since an interactive <file>debian/rules</file> script makes it
1771 impossible to auto-compile that package and also makes it
1772 hard for other people to reproduce the same binary
1773 package, all <em>required targets</em> must be
1774 non-interactive. At a minimum, required targets are the
1775 ones called by <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>, namely,
1776 <em>clean</em>, <em>binary</em>, <em>binary-arch</em>,
1777 <em>binary-indep</em>, and <em>build</em>. It also follows
1778 that any target that these targets depend on must also be
1783 The targets are as follows (required unless stated otherwise):
1785 <tag><tt>build</tt></tag>
1788 The <tt>build</tt> target should perform all the
1789 configuration and compilation of the package.
1790 If a package has an interactive pre-build
1791 configuration routine, the Debianized source package
1792 must either be built after this has taken place (so
1793 that the binary package can be built without rerunning
1794 the configuration) or the configuration routine
1795 modified to become non-interactive. (The latter is
1796 preferable if there are architecture-specific features
1797 detected by the configuration routine.)
1801 For some packages, notably ones where the same
1802 source tree is compiled in different ways to produce
1803 two binary packages, the <tt>build</tt> target
1804 does not make much sense. For these packages it is
1805 good enough to provide two (or more) targets
1806 (<tt>build-a</tt> and <tt>build-b</tt> or whatever)
1807 for each of the ways of building the package, and a
1808 <tt>build</tt> target that does nothing. The
1809 <tt>binary</tt> target will have to build the
1810 package in each of the possible ways and make the
1811 binary package out of each.
1815 The <tt>build</tt> target must not do anything
1816 that might require root privilege.
1820 The <tt>build</tt> target may need to run the
1821 <tt>clean</tt> target first - see below.
1825 When a package has a configuration and build routine
1826 which takes a long time, or when the makefiles are
1827 poorly designed, or when <tt>build</tt> needs to
1828 run <tt>clean</tt> first, it is a good idea to
1829 <tt>touch build</tt> when the build process is
1830 complete. This will ensure that if <tt>debian/rules
1831 build</tt> is run again it will not rebuild the whole
1833 Another common way to do this is for <tt>build</tt>
1834 to depend on <prgn>build-stamp</prgn> and to do
1835 nothing else, and for the <prgn>build-stamp</prgn>
1836 target to do the building and to <tt>touch
1837 build-stamp</tt> on completion. This is
1838 especially useful if the build routine creates a
1839 file or directory called <tt>build</tt>; in such a
1840 case, <tt>build</tt> will need to be listed as
1841 a phony target (i.e., as a dependency of the
1842 <tt>.PHONY</tt> target). See the documentation of
1843 <prgn>make</prgn> for more information on phony
1849 <tag><tt>build-arch</tt> (optional),
1850 <tt>build-indep</tt> (optional)
1854 A package may also provide both of the targets
1855 <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt>.
1856 The <tt>build-arch</tt> target, if provided, should
1857 perform all the configuration and compilation required for
1858 producing all architecture-dependant binary packages
1859 (those packages for which the body of the
1860 <tt>Architecture</tt> field in <tt>debian/control</tt> is
1861 not <tt>all</tt>). Similarly, the <tt>build-indep</tt>
1862 target, if provided, should perform all the configuration
1863 and compilation required for producing all
1864 architecture-independent binary packages (those packages
1865 for which the body of the <tt>Architecture</tt> field
1866 in <tt>debian/control</tt> is <tt>all</tt>).
1867 The <tt>build</tt> target should depend on those of the
1868 targets <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt> that
1869 are provided in the rules file.<footnote>
1870 The intent of this split is so that binary-only builds
1871 need not install the dependencies required for
1872 the <tt>build-indep</tt> target. However, this is not
1873 yet used in practice since <tt>dpkg-buildpackage
1874 -B</tt>, and therefore the autobuilders,
1875 invoke <tt>build</tt> rather than <tt>build-arch</tt>
1876 due to the difficulties in determining whether the
1877 optional <tt>build-arch</tt> target exists.
1882 If one or both of the targets <tt>build-arch</tt> and
1883 <tt>build-indep</tt> are not provided, then invoking
1884 <file>debian/rules</file> with one of the not-provided
1885 targets as arguments should produce a exit status code
1886 of 2. Usually this is provided automatically by make
1887 if the target is missing.
1891 The <tt>build-arch</tt> and <tt>build-indep</tt> targets
1892 must not do anything that might require root privilege.
1896 <tag><tt>binary</tt>, <tt>binary-arch</tt>,
1897 <tt>binary-indep</tt>
1901 The <tt>binary</tt> target must be all that is
1902 necessary for the user to build the binary package(s)
1903 produced from this source package. It is
1904 split into two parts: <prgn>binary-arch</prgn> builds
1905 the binary packages which are specific to a particular
1906 architecture, and <tt>binary-indep</tt> builds
1907 those which are not.
1910 <tt>binary</tt> may be (and commonly is) a target with
1911 no commands which simply depends on
1912 <tt>binary-arch</tt> and <tt>binary-indep</tt>.
1915 Both <tt>binary-*</tt> targets should depend on the
1916 <tt>build</tt> target, or on the appropriate
1917 <tt>build-arch</tt> or <tt>build-indep</tt> target, if
1918 provided, so that the package is built if it has not
1919 been already. It should then create the relevant
1920 binary package(s), using <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
1921 make their control files and <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> to
1922 build them and place them in the parent of the top
1927 Both the <tt>binary-arch</tt> and
1928 <tt>binary-indep</tt> targets <em>must</em> exist.
1929 If one of them has nothing to do (which will always be
1930 the case if the source generates only a single binary
1931 package, whether architecture-dependent or not), it
1932 must still exist and must always succeed.
1936 The <tt>binary</tt> targets must be invoked as
1938 The <prgn>fakeroot</prgn> package often allows one
1939 to build a package correctly even without being
1945 <tag><tt>clean</tt></tag>
1948 This must undo any effects that the <tt>build</tt>
1949 and <tt>binary</tt> targets may have had, except
1950 that it should leave alone any output files created in
1951 the parent directory by a run of a <tt>binary</tt>
1956 If a <tt>build</tt> file is touched at the end of
1957 the <tt>build</tt> target, as suggested above, it
1958 should be removed as the first action that
1959 <tt>clean</tt> performs, so that running
1960 <tt>build</tt> again after an interrupted
1961 <tt>clean</tt> doesn't think that everything is
1966 The <tt>clean</tt> target may need to be
1967 invoked as root if <tt>binary</tt> has been
1968 invoked since the last <tt>clean</tt>, or if
1969 <tt>build</tt> has been invoked as root (since
1970 <tt>build</tt> may create directories, for
1975 <tag><tt>get-orig-source</tt> (optional)</tag>
1978 This target fetches the most recent version of the
1979 original source package from a canonical archive site
1980 (via FTP or WWW, for example), does any necessary
1981 rearrangement to turn it into the original source
1982 tar file format described below, and leaves it in the
1987 This target may be invoked in any directory, and
1988 should take care to clean up any temporary files it
1993 This target is optional, but providing it if
1994 possible is a good idea.
1998 <tag><tt>patch</tt> (optional)</tag>
2001 This target performs whatever additional actions are
2002 required to make the source ready for editing (unpacking
2003 additional upstream archives, applying patches, etc.).
2004 It is recommended to be implemented for any package where
2005 <tt>dpkg-source -x</tt> does not result in source ready
2006 for additional modification. See
2007 <ref id="readmesource">.
2013 The <tt>build</tt>, <tt>binary</tt> and
2014 <tt>clean</tt> targets must be invoked with the current
2015 directory being the package's top-level directory.
2020 Additional targets may exist in <file>debian/rules</file>,
2021 either as published or undocumented interfaces or for the
2022 package's internal use.
2026 The architectures we build on and build for are determined
2027 by <prgn>make</prgn> variables using the utility
2028 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-architecture"><prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn></qref>.
2029 You can determine the
2030 Debian architecture and the GNU style architecture
2031 specification string for the build machine (the machine type
2032 we are building on) as well as for the host machine (the
2033 machine type we are building for). Here is a list of
2034 supported <prgn>make</prgn> variables:
2035 <list compact="compact">
2037 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH</tt> (the Debian architecture)
2040 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_CPU</tt> (the Debian CPU name)
2043 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_OS</tt> (the Debian System name)
2046 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt> (the GNU style architecture
2047 specification string)
2050 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_CPU</tt> (the CPU part of
2051 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt>)
2054 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_SYSTEM</tt> (the System part of
2055 <tt>DEB_*_GNU_TYPE</tt>)
2057 where <tt>*</tt> is either <tt>BUILD</tt> for specification of
2058 the build machine or <tt>HOST</tt> for specification of the
2063 Backward compatibility can be provided in the rules file
2064 by setting the needed variables to suitable default
2065 values; please refer to the documentation of
2066 <prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn> for details.
2070 It is important to understand that the <tt>DEB_*_ARCH</tt>
2071 string only determines which Debian architecture we are
2072 building on or for. It should not be used to get the CPU
2073 or system information; the <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_CPU</tt> and
2074 <tt>DEB_*_ARCH_OS</tt> variables should be used for that.
2075 GNU style variables should generally only be used with upstream
2079 <sect1 id="debianrules-options">
2080 <heading><file>debian/rules</file> and
2081 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt></heading>
2084 Supporting the standardized environment variable
2085 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt> is recommended. This variable can
2086 contain several flags to change how a package is compiled and
2087 built. Each flag must be in the form <var>flag</var> or
2088 <var>flag</var>=<var>options</var>. If multiple flags are
2089 given, they must be separated by whitespace.<footnote>
2090 Some packages support any delimiter, but whitespace is the
2091 easiest to parse inside a makefile and avoids ambiguity with
2092 flag values that contain commas.
2094 <var>flag</var> must start with a lowercase letter
2095 (<tt>a-z</tt>) and consist only of lowercase letters,
2096 numbers (<tt>0-9</tt>), and the characters
2097 <tt>-</tt> and <tt>_</tt> (hyphen and underscore).
2098 <var>options</var> must not contain whitespace. The same
2099 tag should not be given multiple times with conflicting
2100 values. Package maintainers may assume that
2101 <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt> will not contain conflicting tags.
2105 The meaning of the following tags has been standardized:
2109 This tag says to not run any build-time test suite
2110 provided by the package.
2114 The presence of this tag means that the package should
2115 be compiled with a minimum of optimization. For C
2116 programs, it is best to add <tt>-O0</tt> to
2117 <tt>CFLAGS</tt> (although this is usually the default).
2118 Some programs might fail to build or run at this level
2119 of optimization; it may be necessary to use
2120 <tt>-O1</tt>, for example.
2124 This tag means that the debugging symbols should not be
2125 stripped from the binary during installation, so that
2126 debugging information may be included in the package.
2128 <tag>parallel=n</tag>
2130 This tag means that the package should be built using up
2131 to <tt>n</tt> parallel processes if the package build
2132 system supports this.<footnote>
2133 Packages built with <tt>make</tt> can often implement
2134 this by passing the <tt>-j</tt><var>n</var> option to
2137 If the package build system does not support parallel
2138 builds, this string must be ignored. If the package
2139 build system only supports a lower level of concurrency
2140 than <var>n</var>, the package should be built using as
2141 many parallel processes as the package build system
2142 supports. It is up to the package maintainer to decide
2143 whether the package build times are long enough and the
2144 package build system is robust enough to make supporting
2145 parallel builds worthwhile.
2151 Unknown flags must be ignored by <file>debian/rules</file>.
2155 The following makefile snippet is an example of how one may
2156 implement the build options; you will probably have to
2157 massage this example in order to make it work for your
2159 <example compact="compact">
2162 INSTALL_FILE = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 644
2163 INSTALL_PROGRAM = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 755
2164 INSTALL_SCRIPT = $(INSTALL) -p -o root -g root -m 755
2165 INSTALL_DIR = $(INSTALL) -p -d -o root -g root -m 755
2167 ifneq (,$(filter noopt,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2172 ifeq (,$(filter nostrip,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2173 INSTALL_PROGRAM += -s
2175 ifneq (,$(filter parallel=%,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2176 NUMJOBS = $(patsubst parallel=%,%,$(filter parallel=%,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2177 MAKEFLAGS += -j$(NUMJOBS)
2182 ifeq (,$(filter nocheck,$(DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS)))
2183 # Code to run the package test suite.
2190 <!-- FIXME: section pkg-srcsubstvars is the same as substvars -->
2191 <sect id="substvars">
2192 <heading>Variable substitutions: <file>debian/substvars</file></heading>
2195 When <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>,
2196 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> and <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
2197 generate control files they perform variable substitutions
2198 on their output just before writing it. Variable
2199 substitutions have the form <tt>${<var>variable</var>}</tt>.
2200 The optional file <file>debian/substvars</file> contains
2201 variable substitutions to be used; variables can also be set
2202 directly from <file>debian/rules</file> using the <tt>-V</tt>
2203 option to the source packaging commands, and certain
2204 predefined variables are also available.
2208 The <file>debian/substvars</file> file is usually generated and
2209 modified dynamically by <file>debian/rules</file> targets, in
2210 which case it must be removed by the <tt>clean</tt> target.
2214 See <manref name="deb-substvars" section="5"> for full
2215 details about source variable substitutions, including the
2216 format of <file>debian/substvars</file>.</p>
2219 <sect id="debianwatch">
2220 <heading>Optional upstream source location: <file>debian/watch</file></heading>
2223 This is an optional, recommended control file for the
2224 <tt>uscan</tt> utility which defines how to automatically
2225 scan ftp or http sites for newly available updates of the
2226 package. This is used by <url id="
2227 http://dehs.alioth.debian.org/"> and other Debian QA tools
2228 to help with quality control and maintenance of the
2229 distribution as a whole.
2234 <sect id="debianfiles">
2235 <heading>Generated files list: <file>debian/files</file></heading>
2238 This file is not a permanent part of the source tree; it
2239 is used while building packages to record which files are
2240 being generated. <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> uses it
2241 when it generates a <file>.changes</file> file.
2245 It should not exist in a shipped source package, and so it
2246 (and any backup files or temporary files such as
2247 <file>files.new</file><footnote>
2248 <file>files.new</file> is used as a temporary file by
2249 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> and
2250 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> - they write a new
2251 version of <tt>files</tt> here before renaming it,
2252 to avoid leaving a corrupted copy if an error
2254 </footnote>) should be removed by the
2255 <tt>clean</tt> target. It may also be wise to
2256 ensure a fresh start by emptying or removing it at the
2257 start of the <tt>binary</tt> target.
2261 When <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> is run for a binary
2262 package, it adds an entry to <file>debian/files</file> for the
2263 <file>.deb</file> file that will be created when <tt>dpkg-deb
2264 --build</tt> is run for that binary package. So for most
2265 packages all that needs to be done with this file is to
2266 delete it in the <tt>clean</tt> target.
2270 If a package upload includes files besides the source
2271 package and any binary packages whose control files were
2272 made with <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> then they should be
2273 placed in the parent of the package's top-level directory
2274 and <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> should be called to add
2275 the file to the list in <file>debian/files</file>.</p>
2278 <sect id="embeddedfiles">
2279 <heading>Convenience copies of code</heading>
2282 Some software packages include in their distribution convenience
2283 copies of code from other software packages, generally so that
2284 users compiling from source don't have to download multiple
2285 packages. Debian packages should not make use of these
2286 convenience copies unless the included package is explicitly
2287 intended to be used in this way.<footnote>
2288 For example, parts of the GNU build system work like this.
2290 If the included code is already in the Debian archive in the
2291 form of a library, the Debian packaging should ensure that
2292 binary packages reference the libraries already in Debian and
2293 the convenience copy is not used. If the included code is not
2294 already in Debian, it should be packaged separately as a
2295 prerequisite if possible.
2297 Having multiple copies of the same code in Debian is
2298 inefficient, often creates either static linking or shared
2299 library conflicts, and, most importantly, increases the
2300 difficulty of handling security vulnerabilities in the
2306 <sect id="readmesource">
2307 <heading>Source package handling:
2308 <file>debian/README.source</file></heading>
2311 If running <prgn>dpkg-source -x</prgn> on a source package
2312 doesn't produce the source of the package, ready for editing,
2313 and allow one to make changes and run
2314 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> to produce a modified package
2315 without taking any additional steps, creating a
2316 <file>debian/README.source</file> documentation file is
2317 recommended. This file should explain how to do all of the
2320 <item>Generate the fully patched source, in a form ready for
2321 editing, that would be built to create Debian
2322 packages. Doing this with a <tt>patch</tt> target in
2323 <file>debian/rules</file> is recommended; see
2324 <ref id="debianrules">.</item>
2325 <item>Modify the source and save those modifications so that
2326 they will be applied when building the package.</item>
2327 <item>Remove source modifications that are currently being
2328 applied when building the package.</item>
2329 <item>Optionally, document what steps are necessary to
2330 upgrade the Debian source package to a new upstream version,
2331 if applicable.</item>
2333 This explanation should include specific commands and mention
2334 any additional required Debian packages. It should not assume
2335 familiarity with any specific Debian packaging system or patch
2340 This explanation may refer to a documentation file installed by
2341 one of the package's build dependencies provided that the
2342 referenced documentation clearly explains these tasks and is not
2343 a general reference manual.
2347 <file>debian/README.source</file> may also include any other
2348 information that would be helpful to someone modifying the
2349 source package. Even if the package doesn't fit the above
2350 description, maintainers are encouraged to document in a
2351 <file>debian/README.source</file> file any source package with a
2352 particularly complex or unintuitive source layout or build
2353 system (for example, a package that builds the same source
2354 multiple times to generate different binary packages).
2360 <chapt id="controlfields">
2361 <heading>Control files and their fields</heading>
2364 The package management system manipulates data represented in
2365 a common format, known as <em>control data</em>, stored in
2366 <em>control files</em>.
2367 Control files are used for source packages, binary packages and
2368 the <file>.changes</file> files which control the installation
2369 of uploaded files<footnote>
2370 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s internal databases are in a similar
2375 <sect id="controlsyntax">
2376 <heading>Syntax of control files</heading>
2379 A control file consists of one or more paragraphs of
2381 The paragraphs are also sometimes referred to as stanzas.
2383 The paragraphs are separated by blank lines. Some control
2384 files allow only one paragraph; others allow several, in
2385 which case each paragraph usually refers to a different
2386 package. (For example, in source packages, the first
2387 paragraph refers to the source package, and later paragraphs
2388 refer to binary packages generated from the source.)
2392 Each paragraph consists of a series of data fields; each
2393 field consists of the field name, followed by a colon and
2394 then the data/value associated with that field. It ends at
2395 the end of the (logical) line. Horizontal whitespace
2396 (spaces and tabs) may occur immediately before or after the
2397 value and is ignored there; it is conventional to put a
2398 single space after the colon. For example, a field might
2400 <example compact="compact">
2403 the field name is <tt>Package</tt> and the field value
2408 Many fields' values may span several lines; in this case
2409 each continuation line must start with a space or a tab.
2410 Any trailing spaces or tabs at the end of individual
2411 lines of a field value are ignored.
2415 In fields where it is specified that lines may not wrap,
2416 only a single line of data is allowed and whitespace is not
2417 significant in a field body. Whitespace must not appear
2418 inside names (of packages, architectures, files or anything
2419 else) or version numbers, or between the characters of
2420 multi-character version relationships.
2424 Field names are not case-sensitive, but it is usual to
2425 capitalize the field names using mixed case as shown below.
2426 Field values are case-sensitive unless the description of the
2427 field says otherwise.
2431 Blank lines, or lines consisting only of spaces and tabs,
2432 are not allowed within field values or between fields - that
2433 would mean a new paragraph.
2437 All control files must be encoded in UTF-8.
2441 <sect id="sourcecontrolfiles">
2442 <heading>Source package control files -- <file>debian/control</file></heading>
2445 The <file>debian/control</file> file contains the most vital
2446 (and version-independent) information about the source package
2447 and about the binary packages it creates.
2451 The first paragraph of the control file contains information about
2452 the source package in general. The subsequent sets each describe a
2453 binary package that the source tree builds.
2457 The fields in the general paragraph (the first one, for the source
2460 <list compact="compact">
2461 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2462 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2463 <item><qref id="f-Uploaders"><tt>Uploaders</tt></qref></item>
2464 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2465 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2466 <item><qref id="sourcebinarydeps"><tt>Build-Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2467 <item><qref id="f-Standards-Version"><tt>Standards-Version</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2468 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2473 The fields in the binary package paragraphs are:
2475 <list compact="compact">
2476 <item><qref id="f-Package"><tt>Package</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2477 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2478 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2479 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2480 <item><qref id="f-Essential"><tt>Essential</tt></qref></item>
2481 <item><qref id="binarydeps"><tt>Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2482 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2483 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2488 The syntax and semantics of the fields are described below.
2492 These fields are used by <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
2493 generate control files for binary packages (see below), by
2494 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> to generate the
2495 <tt>.changes</tt> file to accompany the upload, and by
2496 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> when it creates the
2497 <file>.dsc</file> source control file as part of a source
2498 archive. Many fields are permitted to span multiple lines in
2499 <file>debian/control</file> but not in any other control
2500 file. These tools are responsible for removing the line
2501 breaks from such fields when using fields from
2502 <file>debian/control</file> to generate other control files.
2506 The fields here may contain variable references - their
2507 values will be substituted by <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>,
2508 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> or <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
2509 when they generate output control files.
2510 See <ref id="substvars"> for details.
2514 In addition to the control file syntax described <qref
2515 id="controlsyntax">above</qref>, this file may also contain
2516 comment lines starting with <tt>#</tt> without any preceding
2517 whitespace. All such lines are ignored, even in the middle of
2518 continuation lines for a multiline field, and do not end a
2524 <sect id="binarycontrolfiles">
2525 <heading>Binary package control files -- <file>DEBIAN/control</file></heading>
2528 The <file>DEBIAN/control</file> file contains the most vital
2529 (and version-dependent) information about a binary package.
2533 The fields in this file are:
2535 <list compact="compact">
2536 <item><qref id="f-Package"><tt>Package</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2537 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref></item>
2538 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2539 <item><qref id="f-Section"><tt>Section</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2540 <item><qref id="f-Priority"><tt>Priority</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2541 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2542 <item><qref id="f-Essential"><tt>Essential</tt></qref></item>
2543 <item><qref id="binarydeps"><tt>Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2544 <item><qref id="f-Installed-Size"><tt>Installed-Size</tt></qref></item>
2545 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2546 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2547 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2552 <sect id="debiansourcecontrolfiles">
2553 <heading>Debian source control files -- <tt>.dsc</tt></heading>
2556 This file contains a series of fields, identified and
2557 separated just like the fields in the control file of
2558 a binary package. The fields are listed below; their
2559 syntax is described above, in <ref id="pkg-controlfields">.
2561 <list compact="compact">
2562 <item><qref id="f-Format"><tt>Format</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2563 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2564 <item><qref id="f-Binary"><tt>Binary</tt></qref></item>
2565 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref></item>
2566 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2567 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2568 <item><qref id="f-Uploaders"><tt>Uploaders</tt></qref></item>
2569 <item><qref id="f-Homepage"><tt>Homepage</tt></qref></item>
2570 <item><qref id="f-Standards-Version"><tt>Standards-Version</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2571 <item><qref id="sourcebinarydeps"><tt>Build-Depends</tt> et al</qref></item>
2572 <item><qref id="f-Checksums"><tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt>
2573 and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt> (recommended)</item>
2574 <item><qref id="f-Files"><tt>Files</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2579 The source package control file is generated by
2580 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> when it builds the source
2581 archive, from other files in the source package,
2582 described above. When unpacking, it is checked against
2583 the files and directories in the other parts of the
2589 <sect id="debianchangesfiles">
2590 <heading>Debian changes files -- <file>.changes</file></heading>
2593 The .changes files are used by the Debian archive maintenance
2594 software to process updates to packages. They contain one
2595 paragraph which contains information from the
2596 <tt>debian/control</tt> file and other data about the
2597 source package gathered via <tt>debian/changelog</tt>
2598 and <tt>debian/rules</tt>.
2602 The fields in this file are:
2604 <list compact="compact">
2605 <item><qref id="f-Format"><tt>Format</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2606 <item><qref id="f-Date"><tt>Date</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2607 <item><qref id="f-Source"><tt>Source</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2608 <item><qref id="f-Binary"><tt>Binary</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2609 <item><qref id="f-Architecture"><tt>Architecture</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2610 <item><qref id="f-Version"><tt>Version</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2611 <item><qref id="f-Distribution"><tt>Distribution</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2612 <item><qref id="f-Urgency"><tt>Urgency</tt></qref> (recommended)</item>
2613 <item><qref id="f-Maintainer"><tt>Maintainer</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2614 <item><qref id="f-Changed-By"><tt>Changed-By</tt></qref></item>
2615 <item><qref id="f-Description"><tt>Description</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2616 <item><qref id="f-Closes"><tt>Closes</tt></qref></item>
2617 <item><qref id="f-Changes"><tt>Changes</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2618 <item><qref id="f-Checksums"><tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt>
2619 and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt> (recommended)</item>
2620 <item><qref id="f-Files"><tt>Files</tt></qref> (mandatory)</item>
2625 <sect id="controlfieldslist">
2626 <heading>List of fields</heading>
2628 <sect1 id="f-Source">
2629 <heading><tt>Source</tt></heading>
2632 This field identifies the source package name.
2636 In <file>debian/control</file> or a <file>.dsc</file> file,
2637 this field must contain only the name of the source package.
2641 In a binary package control file or a <file>.changes</file>
2642 file, the source package name may be followed by a version
2643 number in parentheses<footnote>
2644 It is customary to leave a space after the package name
2645 if a version number is specified.
2647 This version number may be omitted (and is, by
2648 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>) if it has the same value as
2649 the <tt>Version</tt> field of the binary package in
2650 question. The field itself may be omitted from a binary
2651 package control file when the source package has the same
2652 name and version as the binary package.
2656 Package names (both source and binary,
2657 see <ref id="f-Package">) must consist only of lower case
2658 letters (<tt>a-z</tt>), digits (<tt>0-9</tt>), plus
2659 (<tt>+</tt>) and minus (<tt>-</tt>) signs, and periods
2660 (<tt>.</tt>). They must be at least two characters long and
2661 must start with an alphanumeric character.
2665 <sect1 id="f-Maintainer">
2666 <heading><tt>Maintainer</tt></heading>
2669 The package maintainer's name and email address. The name
2670 should come first, then the email address inside angle
2671 brackets <tt><></tt> (in RFC822 format).
2675 If the maintainer's name contains a full stop then the
2676 whole field will not work directly as an email address due
2677 to a misfeature in the syntax specified in RFC822; a
2678 program using this field as an address must check for this
2679 and correct the problem if necessary (for example by
2680 putting the name in round brackets and moving it to the
2681 end, and bringing the email address forward).
2685 <sect1 id="f-Uploaders">
2686 <heading><tt>Uploaders</tt></heading>
2689 List of the names and email addresses of co-maintainers of
2690 the package, if any. If the package has other maintainers
2691 beside the one named in the
2692 <qref id="f-Maintainer">Maintainer field</qref>, their
2693 names and email addresses should be listed here. The
2694 format is the same as that of the Maintainer tag, and
2695 multiple entries should be comma separated. Currently,
2696 this field is restricted to a single line of data. This
2697 is an optional field.
2700 Any parser that interprets the Uploaders field in
2701 <file>debian/control</file> must permit it to span multiple
2702 lines. Line breaks in an Uploaders field that spans multiple
2703 lines are not significant and the semantics of the field are
2704 the same as if the line breaks had not been present.
2708 <sect1 id="f-Changed-By">
2709 <heading><tt>Changed-By</tt></heading>
2712 The name and email address of the person who changed the
2713 said package. Usually the name of the maintainer.
2714 All the rules for the Maintainer field apply here, too.
2718 <sect1 id="f-Section">
2719 <heading><tt>Section</tt></heading>
2722 This field specifies an application area into which the package
2723 has been classified. See <ref id="subsections">.
2727 When it appears in the <file>debian/control</file> file,
2728 it gives the value for the subfield of the same name in
2729 the <tt>Files</tt> field of the <file>.changes</file> file.
2730 It also gives the default for the same field in the binary
2735 <sect1 id="f-Priority">
2736 <heading><tt>Priority</tt></heading>
2739 This field represents how important it is that the user
2740 have the package installed. See <ref id="priorities">.
2744 When it appears in the <file>debian/control</file> file,
2745 it gives the value for the subfield of the same name in
2746 the <tt>Files</tt> field of the <file>.changes</file> file.
2747 It also gives the default for the same field in the binary
2752 <sect1 id="f-Package">
2753 <heading><tt>Package</tt></heading>
2756 The name of the binary package.
2760 Binary package names must follow the same syntax and
2761 restrictions as source package names. See <ref id="f-Source">
2766 <sect1 id="f-Architecture">
2767 <heading><tt>Architecture</tt></heading>
2770 Depending on context and the control file used, the
2771 <tt>Architecture</tt> field can include the following sets of
2775 A unique single word identifying a Debian machine
2776 architecture as described in <ref id="arch-spec">.
2779 An architecture wildcard identifying a set of Debian
2780 machine architectures, see <ref id="arch-wildcard-spec">.
2781 <tt>any</tt> matches all Debian machine architectures
2782 and is the most frequently used.
2785 <tt>all</tt>, which indicates an
2786 architecture-independent package.
2789 <tt>source</tt>, which indicates a source package.
2795 In the main <file>debian/control</file> file in the source
2796 package, this field may contain the special
2797 value <tt>all</tt>, the special architecture
2798 wildcard <tt>any</tt>, or a list of specific and wildcard
2799 architectures separated by spaces. If <tt>all</tt>
2800 or <tt>any</tt> appears, that value must be the entire
2801 contents of the field. Most packages will use
2802 either <tt>all</tt> or <tt>any</tt>.
2806 Specifying a specific list of architectures indicates that the
2807 source will build an architecture-dependent package only on
2808 architectures included in the list. Specifying a list of
2809 architecture wildcards indicates that the source will build an
2810 architecture-dependent package on only those architectures
2811 that match any of the specified architecture wildcards.
2812 Specifying a list of architectures or architecture wildcards
2813 other than <tt>any</tt> is for the minority of cases where a
2814 program is not portable or is not useful on some
2815 architectures. Where possible, the program should be made
2820 In the source package control file <file>.dsc</file>, this
2821 field may contain either the architecture
2822 wildcard <tt>any</tt> or a list of architectures and
2823 architecture wildcards separated by spaces. If a list is
2824 given, it may include (or consist solely of) the special
2825 value <tt>all</tt>. In other words, in <file>.dsc</file>
2826 files unlike the <file>debian/control</file>, <tt>all</tt> may
2827 occur in combination with specific architectures.
2828 The <tt>Architecture</tt> field in the source package control
2829 file <file>.dsc</file> is generally constructed from
2830 the <tt>Architecture</tt> fields in
2831 the <file>debian/control</file> in the source package.
2835 Specifying <tt>any</tt> indicates that the source package
2836 isn't dependent on any particular architecture and should
2837 compile fine on any one. The produced binary package(s)
2838 will either be specific to whatever the current build
2839 architecture is or will be architecture-independent.
2843 Specifying only <tt>all</tt> indicates that the source package
2844 will only build architecture-independent packages. If this is
2845 the case, <tt>all</tt> must be used rather than <tt>any</tt>;
2846 <tt>any</tt> implies that the source package will build at
2847 least one architecture-dependent package.
2851 Specifying a list of architectures or architecture wildcards
2852 indicates that the source will build an architecture-dependent
2853 package, and will only work correctly on the listed or
2854 matching architectures. If the source package also builds at
2855 least one architecture-independent package, <tt>all</tt> will
2856 also be included in the list.
2860 In a <file>.changes</file> file, the <tt>Architecture</tt>
2861 field lists the architecture(s) of the package(s) currently
2862 being uploaded. This will be a list; if the source for the
2863 package is also being uploaded, the special
2864 entry <tt>source</tt> is also present. <tt>all</tt> will be
2865 present if any architecture-independent packages are being
2866 uploaded. Architecture wildcards such as <tt>any</tt> must
2867 never occur in the <tt>Architecture</tt> field in
2868 the <file>.changes</file> file.
2872 See <ref id="debianrules"> for information on how to get
2873 the architecture for the build process.
2877 <sect1 id="f-Essential">
2878 <heading><tt>Essential</tt></heading>
2881 This is a boolean field which may occur only in the
2882 control file of a binary package or in a per-package fields
2883 paragraph of a main source control data file.
2887 If set to <tt>yes</tt> then the package management system
2888 will refuse to remove the package (upgrading and replacing
2889 it is still possible). The other possible value is <tt>no</tt>,
2890 which is the same as not having the field at all.
2895 <heading>Package interrelationship fields:
2896 <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
2897 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>,
2898 <tt>Breaks</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt>,
2899 <tt>Provides</tt>, <tt>Replaces</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>
2903 These fields describe the package's relationships with
2904 other packages. Their syntax and semantics are described
2905 in <ref id="relationships">.</p>
2908 <sect1 id="f-Standards-Version">
2909 <heading><tt>Standards-Version</tt></heading>
2912 The most recent version of the standards (the policy
2913 manual and associated texts) with which the package
2918 The version number has four components: major and minor
2919 version number and major and minor patch level. When the
2920 standards change in a way that requires every package to
2921 change the major number will be changed. Significant
2922 changes that will require work in many packages will be
2923 signaled by a change to the minor number. The major patch
2924 level will be changed for any change to the meaning of the
2925 standards, however small; the minor patch level will be
2926 changed when only cosmetic, typographical or other edits
2927 are made which neither change the meaning of the document
2928 nor affect the contents of packages.
2932 Thus only the first three components of the policy version
2933 are significant in the <em>Standards-Version</em> control
2934 field, and so either these three components or all four
2935 components may be specified.<footnote>
2936 In the past, people specified the full version number
2937 in the Standards-Version field, for example "2.3.0.0".
2938 Since minor patch-level changes don't introduce new
2939 policy, it was thought it would be better to relax
2940 policy and only require the first 3 components to be
2941 specified, in this example "2.3.0". All four
2942 components may still be used if someone wishes to do so.
2948 <sect1 id="f-Version">
2949 <heading><tt>Version</tt></heading>
2952 The version number of a package. The format is:
2953 [<var>epoch</var><tt>:</tt>]<var>upstream_version</var>[<tt>-</tt><var>debian_revision</var>]
2957 The three components here are:
2959 <tag><var>epoch</var></tag>
2962 This is a single (generally small) unsigned integer. It
2963 may be omitted, in which case zero is assumed. If it is
2964 omitted then the <var>upstream_version</var> may not
2969 It is provided to allow mistakes in the version numbers
2970 of older versions of a package, and also a package's
2971 previous version numbering schemes, to be left behind.
2975 <tag><var>upstream_version</var></tag>
2978 This is the main part of the version number. It is
2979 usually the version number of the original ("upstream")
2980 package from which the <file>.deb</file> file has been made,
2981 if this is applicable. Usually this will be in the same
2982 format as that specified by the upstream author(s);
2983 however, it may need to be reformatted to fit into the
2984 package management system's format and comparison
2989 The comparison behavior of the package management system
2990 with respect to the <var>upstream_version</var> is
2991 described below. The <var>upstream_version</var>
2992 portion of the version number is mandatory.
2996 The <var>upstream_version</var> may contain only
2997 alphanumerics<footnote>
2998 Alphanumerics are <tt>A-Za-z0-9</tt> only.
3000 and the characters <tt>.</tt> <tt>+</tt> <tt>-</tt>
3001 <tt>:</tt> <tt>~</tt> (full stop, plus, hyphen, colon,
3002 tilde) and should start with a digit. If there is no
3003 <var>debian_revision</var> then hyphens are not allowed;
3004 if there is no <var>epoch</var> then colons are not
3009 <tag><var>debian_revision</var></tag>
3012 This part of the version number specifies the version of
3013 the Debian package based on the upstream version. It
3014 may contain only alphanumerics and the characters
3015 <tt>+</tt> <tt>.</tt> <tt>~</tt> (plus, full stop,
3016 tilde) and is compared in the same way as the
3017 <var>upstream_version</var> is.
3021 It is optional; if it isn't present then the
3022 <var>upstream_version</var> may not contain a hyphen.
3023 This format represents the case where a piece of
3024 software was written specifically to be turned into a
3025 Debian package, and so there is only one "debianisation"
3026 of it and therefore no revision indication is required.
3030 It is conventional to restart the
3031 <var>debian_revision</var> at <tt>1</tt> each time the
3032 <var>upstream_version</var> is increased.
3036 The package management system will break the version
3037 number apart at the last hyphen in the string (if there
3038 is one) to determine the <var>upstream_version</var> and
3039 <var>debian_revision</var>. The absence of a
3040 <var>debian_revision</var> is equivalent to a
3041 <var>debian_revision</var> of <tt>0</tt>.
3048 When comparing two version numbers, first the <var>epoch</var>
3049 of each are compared, then the <var>upstream_version</var> if
3050 <var>epoch</var> is equal, and then <var>debian_revision</var>
3051 if <var>upstream_version</var> is also equal.
3052 <var>epoch</var> is compared numerically. The
3053 <var>upstream_version</var> and <var>debian_revision</var>
3054 parts are compared by the package management system using the
3055 following algorithm:
3059 The strings are compared from left to right.
3063 First the initial part of each string consisting entirely of
3064 non-digit characters is determined. These two parts (one of
3065 which may be empty) are compared lexically. If a difference
3066 is found it is returned. The lexical comparison is a
3067 comparison of ASCII values modified so that all the letters
3068 sort earlier than all the non-letters and so that a tilde
3069 sorts before anything, even the end of a part. For example,
3070 the following parts are in sorted order from earliest to
3071 latest: <tt>~~</tt>, <tt>~~a</tt>, <tt>~</tt>, the empty part,
3072 <tt>a</tt>.<footnote>
3073 One common use of <tt>~</tt> is for upstream pre-releases.
3074 For example, <tt>1.0~beta1~svn1245</tt> sorts earlier than
3075 <tt>1.0~beta1</tt>, which sorts earlier than <tt>1.0</tt>.
3080 Then the initial part of the remainder of each string which
3081 consists entirely of digit characters is determined. The
3082 numerical values of these two parts are compared, and any
3083 difference found is returned as the result of the comparison.
3084 For these purposes an empty string (which can only occur at
3085 the end of one or both version strings being compared) counts
3090 These two steps (comparing and removing initial non-digit
3091 strings and initial digit strings) are repeated until a
3092 difference is found or both strings are exhausted.
3096 Note that the purpose of epochs is to allow us to leave behind
3097 mistakes in version numbering, and to cope with situations
3098 where the version numbering scheme changes. It is
3099 <em>not</em> intended to cope with version numbers containing
3100 strings of letters which the package management system cannot
3101 interpret (such as <tt>ALPHA</tt> or <tt>pre-</tt>), or with
3102 silly orderings.<footnote>
3103 The author of this manual has heard of a package whose
3104 versions went <tt>1.1</tt>, <tt>1.2</tt>, <tt>1.3</tt>,
3105 <tt>1</tt>, <tt>2.1</tt>, <tt>2.2</tt>, <tt>2</tt> and so
3111 <sect1 id="f-Description">
3112 <heading><tt>Description</tt></heading>
3115 In a source or binary control file, the <tt>Description</tt>
3116 field contains a description of the binary package, consisting
3117 of two parts, the synopsis or the short description, and the
3118 long description. The field's format is as follows:
3123 Description: <single line synopsis>
3124 <extended description over several lines>
3129 The lines in the extended description can have these formats:
3135 Those starting with a single space are part of a paragraph.
3136 Successive lines of this form will be word-wrapped when
3137 displayed. The leading space will usually be stripped off.
3141 Those starting with two or more spaces. These will be
3142 displayed verbatim. If the display cannot be panned
3143 horizontally, the displaying program will line wrap them "hard"
3144 (i.e., without taking account of word breaks). If it can they
3145 will be allowed to trail off to the right. None, one or two
3146 initial spaces may be deleted, but the number of spaces
3147 deleted from each line will be the same (so that you can have
3148 indenting work correctly, for example).
3152 Those containing a single space followed by a single full stop
3153 character. These are rendered as blank lines. This is the
3154 <em>only</em> way to get a blank line<footnote>
3155 Completely empty lines will not be rendered as blank lines.
3156 Instead, they will cause the parser to think you're starting
3157 a whole new record in the control file, and will therefore
3158 likely abort with an error.
3163 Those containing a space, a full stop and some more characters.
3164 These are for future expansion. Do not use them.
3170 Do not use tab characters. Their effect is not predictable.
3174 See <ref id="descriptions"> for further information on this.
3178 In a <file>.changes</file> file, the <tt>Description</tt>
3179 field contains a summary of the descriptions for the packages
3180 being uploaded. For this case, the first line of the field
3181 value (the part on the same line as <tt>Description:</tt>) is
3182 always empty. The content of the field is expressed as
3183 continuation lines, one line per package. Each line is
3184 indented by one space and contains the name of a binary
3185 package, a space, a hyphen (<tt>-</tt>), a space, and the
3186 short description line from that package.
3190 <sect1 id="f-Distribution">
3191 <heading><tt>Distribution</tt></heading>
3194 In a <file>.changes</file> file or parsed changelog output
3195 this contains the (space-separated) name(s) of the
3196 distribution(s) where this version of the package should
3197 be installed. Valid distributions are determined by the
3198 archive maintainers.<footnote>
3199 Example distribution names in the Debian archive used in
3200 <file>.changes</file> files are:
3201 <taglist compact="compact">
3202 <tag><em>unstable</em></tag>
3204 This distribution value refers to the
3205 <em>developmental</em> part of the Debian distribution
3206 tree. Most new packages, new upstream versions of
3207 packages and bug fixes go into the <em>unstable</em>
3211 <tag><em>experimental</em></tag>
3213 The packages with this distribution value are deemed
3214 by their maintainers to be high risk. Oftentimes they
3215 represent early beta or developmental packages from
3216 various sources that the maintainers want people to
3217 try, but are not ready to be a part of the other parts
3218 of the Debian distribution tree.
3223 Others are used for updating stable releases or for
3224 security uploads. More information is available in the
3225 Debian Developer's Reference, section "The Debian
3229 The Debian archive software only supports listing a single
3230 distribution. Migration of packages to other distributions is
3231 handled outside of the upload process.
3236 <heading><tt>Date</tt></heading>
3239 This field includes the date the package was built or last
3240 edited. It must be in the same format as the <var>date</var>
3241 in a <file>debian/changelog</file> entry.
3245 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3246 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3247 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">).
3251 <sect1 id="f-Format">
3252 <heading><tt>Format</tt></heading>
3255 This field specifies a format revision for the file.
3256 The most current format described in the Policy Manual
3257 is version <strong>1.5</strong>. The syntax of the
3258 format value is the same as that of a package version
3259 number except that no epoch or Debian revision is allowed
3260 - see <ref id="f-Version">.
3264 <sect1 id="f-Urgency">
3265 <heading><tt>Urgency</tt></heading>
3268 This is a description of how important it is to upgrade to
3269 this version from previous ones. It consists of a single
3270 keyword taking one of the values <tt>low</tt>,
3271 <tt>medium</tt>, <tt>high</tt>, <tt>emergency</tt>, or
3272 <tt>critical</tt><footnote>
3273 Other urgency values are supported with configuration
3274 changes in the archive software but are not used in Debian.
3275 The urgency affects how quickly a package will be considered
3276 for inclusion into the <tt>testing</tt> distribution and
3277 gives an indication of the importance of any fixes included
3278 in the upload. <tt>Emergency</tt> and <tt>critical</tt> are
3279 treated as synonymous.
3280 </footnote> (not case-sensitive) followed by an optional
3281 commentary (separated by a space) which is usually in
3282 parentheses. For example:
3285 Urgency: low (HIGH for users of diversions)
3291 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3292 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3293 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">.
3297 <sect1 id="f-Changes">
3298 <heading><tt>Changes</tt></heading>
3301 This field contains the human-readable changes data, describing
3302 the differences between the last version and the current one.
3306 The first line of the field value (the part on the same line
3307 as <tt>Changes:</tt>) is always empty. The content of the
3308 field is expressed as continuation lines, with each line
3309 indented by at least one space. Blank lines must be
3310 represented by a line consisting only of a space and a full
3315 The value of this field is usually extracted from the
3316 <file>debian/changelog</file> file - see
3317 <ref id="dpkgchangelog">).
3321 Each version's change information should be preceded by a
3322 "title" line giving at least the version, distribution(s)
3323 and urgency, in a human-readable way.
3327 If data from several versions is being returned the entry
3328 for the most recent version should be returned first, and
3329 entries should be separated by the representation of a
3330 blank line (the "title" line may also be followed by the
3331 representation of a blank line).
3335 <sect1 id="f-Binary">
3336 <heading><tt>Binary</tt></heading>
3339 This field is a list of binary packages. Its syntax and
3340 meaning varies depending on the control file in which it
3345 When it appears in the <file>.dsc</file> file, it lists binary
3346 packages which a source package can produce, separated by
3348 A space after each comma is conventional.
3349 </footnote>. It may span multiple lines. The source package
3350 does not necessarily produce all of these binary packages for
3351 every architecture. The source control file doesn't contain
3352 details of which architectures are appropriate for which of
3353 the binary packages.
3357 When it appears in a <file>.changes</file> file, it lists the
3358 names of the binary packages being uploaded, separated by
3359 whitespace (not commas). It may span multiple lines.
3363 <sect1 id="f-Installed-Size">
3364 <heading><tt>Installed-Size</tt></heading>
3367 This field appears in the control files of binary packages,
3368 and in the <file>Packages</file> files. It gives an estimate
3369 of the total amount of disk space required to install the
3370 named package. Actual installed size may vary based on block
3371 size, file system properties, or actions taken by package
3376 The disk space is given as the integer value of the estimated
3377 installed size in bytes, divided by 1024 and rounded up.
3381 <sect1 id="f-Files">
3382 <heading><tt>Files</tt></heading>
3385 This field contains a list of files with information about
3386 each one. The exact information and syntax varies with
3391 In all cases, Files is a multiline field. The first line of
3392 the field value (the part on the same line as <tt>Files:</tt>)
3393 is always empty. The content of the field is expressed as
3394 continuation lines, one line per file. Each line must be
3395 indented by one space and contain a number of sub-fields,
3396 separated by spaces, as described below.
3400 In the <file>.dsc</file> file, each line contains the MD5
3401 checksum, size and filename of the tar file and (if
3402 applicable) diff file which make up the remainder of the
3403 source package<footnote>
3404 That is, the parts which are not the <tt>.dsc</tt>.
3405 </footnote>. For example:
3408 c6f698f19f2a2aa07dbb9bbda90a2754 571925 example_1.2.orig.tar.gz
3409 938512f08422f3509ff36f125f5873ba 6220 example_1.2-1.diff.gz
3411 The exact forms of the filenames are described
3412 in <ref id="pkg-sourcearchives">.
3416 In the <file>.changes</file> file this contains one line per
3417 file being uploaded. Each line contains the MD5 checksum,
3418 size, section and priority and the filename. For example:
3421 4c31ab7bfc40d3cf49d7811987390357 1428 text extra example_1.2-1.dsc
3422 c6f698f19f2a2aa07dbb9bbda90a2754 571925 text extra example_1.2.orig.tar.gz
3423 938512f08422f3509ff36f125f5873ba 6220 text extra example_1.2-1.diff.gz
3424 7c98fe853b3bbb47a00e5cd129b6cb56 703542 text extra example_1.2-1_i386.deb
3426 The <qref id="f-Section">section</qref>
3427 and <qref id="f-Priority">priority</qref> are the values of
3428 the corresponding fields in the main source control file. If
3429 no section or priority is specified then <tt>-</tt> should be
3430 used, though section and priority values must be specified for
3431 new packages to be installed properly.
3435 The special value <tt>byhand</tt> for the section in a
3436 <tt>.changes</tt> file indicates that the file in question
3437 is not an ordinary package file and must by installed by
3438 hand by the distribution maintainers. If the section is
3439 <tt>byhand</tt> the priority should be <tt>-</tt>.
3443 If a new Debian revision of a package is being shipped and
3444 no new original source archive is being distributed the
3445 <tt>.dsc</tt> must still contain the <tt>Files</tt> field
3446 entry for the original source archive
3447 <file><var>package</var>_<var>upstream-version</var>.orig.tar.gz</file>,
3448 but the <file>.changes</file> file should leave it out. In
3449 this case the original source archive on the distribution
3450 site must match exactly, byte-for-byte, the original
3451 source archive which was used to generate the
3452 <file>.dsc</file> file and diff which are being uploaded.</p>
3455 <sect1 id="f-Closes">
3456 <heading><tt>Closes</tt></heading>
3459 A space-separated list of bug report numbers that the upload
3460 governed by the .changes file closes.
3464 <sect1 id="f-Homepage">
3465 <heading><tt>Homepage</tt></heading>
3468 The URL of the web site for this package, preferably (when
3469 applicable) the site from which the original source can be
3470 obtained and any additional upstream documentation or
3471 information may be found. The content of this field is a
3472 simple URL without any surrounding characters such as
3477 <sect1 id="f-Checksums">
3478 <heading><tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt>
3479 and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt></heading>
3482 These fields contain a list of files with a checksum and size
3483 for each one. Both <tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt>
3484 and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt> have the same syntax and differ
3485 only in the checksum algorithm used: SHA-1
3486 for <tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt> and SHA-256
3487 for <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt>.
3491 <tt>Checksums-Sha1</tt> and <tt>Checksums-Sha256</tt> are
3492 multiline fields. The first line of the field value (the part
3493 on the same line as <tt>Checksums-Sha1:</tt>
3494 or <tt>Checksums-Sha256:</tt>) is always empty. The content
3495 of the field is expressed as continuation lines, one line per
3496 file. Each line consists of the checksum, a space, the file
3497 size, a space, and the file name. For example (from
3498 a <file>.changes</file> file):
3501 1f418afaa01464e63cc1ee8a66a05f0848bd155c 1276 example_1.0-1.dsc
3502 a0ed1456fad61116f868b1855530dbe948e20f06 171602 example_1.0.orig.tar.gz
3503 5e86ecf0671e113b63388dac81dd8d00e00ef298 6137 example_1.0-1.debian.tar.gz
3504 71a0ff7da0faaf608481195f9cf30974b142c183 548402 example_1.0-1_i386.deb
3506 ac9d57254f7e835bed299926fd51bf6f534597cc3fcc52db01c4bffedae81272 1276 example_1.0-1.dsc
3507 0d123be7f51e61c4bf15e5c492b484054be7e90f3081608a5517007bfb1fd128 171602 example_1.0.orig.tar.gz
3508 f54ae966a5f580571ae7d9ef5e1df0bd42d63e27cb505b27957351a495bc6288 6137 example_1.0-1.debian.tar.gz
3509 3bec05c03974fdecd11d020fc2e8250de8404867a8a2ce865160c250eb723664 548402 example_1.0-1_i386.deb
3514 In the <file>.dsc</file> file, these fields should list all
3515 files that make up the source package. In
3516 the <file>.changes</file> file, these fields should list all
3517 files being uploaded. The list of files in these fields
3518 must match the list of files in the <tt>Files</tt> field.
3525 <heading>User-defined fields</heading>
3528 Additional user-defined fields may be added to the
3529 source package control file. Such fields will be
3530 ignored, and not copied to (for example) binary or
3531 source package control files or upload control files.
3535 If you wish to add additional unsupported fields to
3536 these output files you should use the mechanism
3541 Fields in the main source control information file with
3542 names starting <tt>X</tt>, followed by one or more of
3543 the letters <tt>BCS</tt> and a hyphen <tt>-</tt>, will
3544 be copied to the output files. Only the part of the
3545 field name after the hyphen will be used in the output
3546 file. Where the letter <tt>B</tt> is used the field
3547 will appear in binary package control files, where the
3548 letter <tt>S</tt> is used in source package control
3549 files and where <tt>C</tt> is used in upload control
3550 (<tt>.changes</tt>) files.
3554 For example, if the main source information control file
3557 XBS-Comment: I stand between the candle and the star.
3559 then the binary and source package control files will contain the
3562 Comment: I stand between the candle and the star.
3571 <chapt id="maintainerscripts">
3572 <heading>Package maintainer scripts and installation procedure</heading>
3575 <heading>Introduction to package maintainer scripts</heading>
3578 It is possible to supply scripts as part of a package which
3579 the package management system will run for you when your
3580 package is installed, upgraded or removed.
3584 These scripts are the files <prgn>preinst</prgn>,
3585 <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn> and
3586 <prgn>postrm</prgn> in the control area of the package.
3587 They must be proper executable files; if they are scripts
3588 (which is recommended), they must start with the usual
3589 <tt>#!</tt> convention. They should be readable and
3590 executable by anyone, and must not be world-writable.
3594 The package management system looks at the exit status from
3595 these scripts. It is important that they exit with a
3596 non-zero status if there is an error, so that the package
3597 management system can stop its processing. For shell
3598 scripts this means that you <em>almost always</em> need to
3599 use <tt>set -e</tt> (this is usually true when writing shell
3600 scripts, in fact). It is also important, of course, that
3601 they exit with a zero status if everything went well.
3605 Additionally, packages interacting with users using
3606 <tt>debconf</tt> in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script should
3607 install a <prgn>config</prgn> script in the control area,
3608 see <ref id="maintscriptprompt"> for details.
3612 When a package is upgraded a combination of the scripts from
3613 the old and new packages is called during the upgrade
3614 procedure. If your scripts are going to be at all
3615 complicated you need to be aware of this, and may need to
3616 check the arguments to your scripts.
3620 Broadly speaking the <prgn>preinst</prgn> is called before
3621 (a particular version of) a package is installed, and the
3622 <prgn>postinst</prgn> afterwards; the <prgn>prerm</prgn>
3623 before (a version of) a package is removed and the
3624 <prgn>postrm</prgn> afterwards.
3628 Programs called from maintainer scripts should not normally
3629 have a path prepended to them. Before installation is
3630 started, the package management system checks to see if the
3631 programs <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>,
3632 <prgn>start-stop-daemon</prgn>, <prgn>install-info</prgn>,
3633 and <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> can be found via the
3634 <tt>PATH</tt> environment variable. Those programs, and any
3635 other program that one would expect to be in the
3636 <tt>PATH</tt>, should thus be invoked without an absolute
3637 pathname. Maintainer scripts should also not reset the
3638 <tt>PATH</tt>, though they might choose to modify it by
3639 prepending or appending package-specific directories. These
3640 considerations really apply to all shell scripts.</p>
3643 <sect id="idempotency">
3644 <heading>Maintainer scripts idempotency</heading>
3647 It is necessary for the error recovery procedures that the
3648 scripts be idempotent. This means that if it is run
3649 successfully, and then it is called again, it doesn't bomb
3650 out or cause any harm, but just ensures that everything is
3651 the way it ought to be. If the first call failed, or
3652 aborted half way through for some reason, the second call
3653 should merely do the things that were left undone the first
3654 time, if any, and exit with a success status if everything
3656 This is so that if an error occurs, the user interrupts
3657 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> or some other unforeseen circumstance
3658 happens you don't leave the user with a badly-broken
3659 package when <prgn>dpkg</prgn> attempts to repeat the
3665 <sect id="controllingterminal">
3666 <heading>Controlling terminal for maintainer scripts</heading>
3669 Maintainer scripts are not guaranteed to run with a controlling
3670 terminal and may not be able to interact with the user. They
3671 must be able to fall back to noninteractive behavior if no
3672 controlling terminal is available. Maintainer scripts that
3673 prompt via a program conforming to the Debian Configuration
3674 Management Specification (see <ref id="maintscriptprompt">) may
3675 assume that program will handle falling back to noninteractive
3680 For high-priority prompts without a reasonable default answer,
3681 maintainer scripts may abort if there is no controlling
3682 terminal. However, this situation should be avoided if at all
3683 possible, since it prevents automated or unattended installs.
3684 In most cases, users will consider this to be a bug in the
3689 <sect id="exitstatus">
3690 <heading>Exit status</heading>
3693 Each script must return a zero exit status for
3694 success, or a nonzero one for failure, since the package
3695 management system looks for the exit status of these scripts
3696 and determines what action to take next based on that datum.
3700 <sect id="mscriptsinstact"><heading>Summary of ways maintainer
3705 <list compact="compact">
3707 <var>new-preinst</var> <tt>install</tt>
3710 <var>new-preinst</var> <tt>install</tt> <var>old-version</var>
3713 <var>new-preinst</var> <tt>upgrade</tt> <var>old-version</var>
3716 <var>old-preinst</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
3717 <var>new-version</var>
3722 <list compact="compact">
3724 <var>postinst</var> <tt>configure</tt>
3725 <var>most-recently-configured-version</var>
3728 <var>old-postinst</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
3729 <var>new-version</var>
3732 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> <tt>abort-remove</tt>
3733 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package</var>
3734 <var>new-version</var>
3737 <var>postinst</var> <tt>abort-remove</tt>
3740 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var>
3741 <tt>abort-deconfigure</tt> <tt>in-favour</tt>
3742 <var>failed-install-package</var> <var>version</var>
3743 [<tt>removing</tt> <var>conflicting-package</var>
3749 <list compact="compact">
3751 <var>prerm</var> <tt>remove</tt>
3754 <var>old-prerm</var> <tt>upgrade</tt>
3755 <var>new-version</var>
3758 <var>new-prerm</var> <tt>failed-upgrade</tt>
3759 <var>old-version</var>
3762 <var>conflictor's-prerm</var> <tt>remove</tt>
3763 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package</var>
3764 <var>new-version</var>
3767 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> <tt>deconfigure</tt>
3768 <tt>in-favour</tt> <var>package-being-installed</var>
3769 <var>version</var> [<tt>removing</tt>
3770 <var>conflicting-package</var>
3776 <list compact="compact">
3778 <var>postrm</var> <tt>remove</tt>
3781 <var>postrm</var> <tt>purge</tt>
3784 <var>old-postrm</var> <tt>upgrade</tt>
3785 <var>new-version</var>
3788 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>failed-upgrade</tt>
3789 <var>old-version</var>
3792 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-install</tt>
3795 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-install</tt>
3796 <var>old-version</var>
3799 <var>new-postrm</var> <tt>abort-upgrade</tt>
3800 <var>old-version</var>
3803 <var>disappearer's-postrm</var> <tt>disappear</tt>
3804 <var>overwriter</var>
3805 <var>overwriter-version</var>
3811 <sect id="unpackphase">
3812 <heading>Details of unpack phase of installation or upgrade</heading>
3815 The procedure on installation/upgrade/overwrite/disappear
3816 (i.e., when running <tt>dpkg --unpack</tt>, or the unpack
3817 stage of <tt>dpkg --install</tt>) is as follows. In each
3818 case, if a major error occurs (unless listed below) the
3819 actions are, in general, run backwards - this means that the
3820 maintainer scripts are run with different arguments in
3821 reverse order. These are the "error unwind" calls listed
3828 If a version of the package is already installed, call
3829 <example compact="compact">
3830 <var>old-prerm</var> upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3834 If the script runs but exits with a non-zero
3835 exit status, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will attempt:
3836 <example compact="compact">
3837 <var>new-prerm</var> failed-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3839 If this works, the upgrade continues. If this
3840 does not work, the error unwind:
3841 <example compact="compact">
3842 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3844 If this works, then the old-version is
3845 "Installed", if not, the old version is in a
3846 "Half-Configured" state.
3852 If a "conflicting" package is being removed at the same time,
3853 or if any package will be broken (due to <tt>Breaks</tt>):
3856 If <tt>--auto-deconfigure</tt> is
3857 specified, call, for each package to be deconfigured
3858 due to <tt>Breaks</tt>:
3859 <example compact="compact">
3860 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> deconfigure \
3861 in-favour <var>package-being-installed</var> <var>version</var>
3864 <example compact="compact">
3865 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var> abort-deconfigure \
3866 in-favour <var>package-being-installed-but-failed</var> <var>version</var>
3868 The deconfigured packages are marked as
3869 requiring configuration, so that if
3870 <tt>--install</tt> is used they will be
3871 configured again if possible.
3874 If any packages depended on a conflicting
3875 package being removed and <tt>--auto-deconfigure</tt> is
3876 specified, call, for each such package:
3877 <example compact="compact">
3878 <var>deconfigured's-prerm</var> deconfigure \
3879 in-favour <var>package-being-installed</var> <var>version</var> \
3880 removing <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>
3883 <example compact="compact">
3884 <var>deconfigured's-postinst</var> abort-deconfigure \
3885 in-favour <var>package-being-installed-but-failed</var> <var>version</var> \
3886 removing <var>conflicting-package</var> <var>version</var>
3888 The deconfigured packages are marked as
3889 requiring configuration, so that if
3890 <tt>--install</tt> is used they will be
3891 configured again if possible.
3894 To prepare for removal of each conflicting package, call:
3895 <example compact="compact">
3896 <var>conflictor's-prerm</var> remove \
3897 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
3900 <example compact="compact">
3901 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> abort-remove \
3902 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
3911 If the package is being upgraded, call:
3912 <example compact="compact">
3913 <var>new-preinst</var> upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3915 If this fails, we call:
3917 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
3924 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
3926 is called. If this works, then the old version
3927 is in an "Installed" state, or else it is left
3928 in an "Unpacked" state.
3933 If it fails, then the old version is left
3934 in an "Half-Installed" state.
3941 Otherwise, if the package had some configuration
3942 files from a previous version installed (i.e., it
3943 is in the "configuration files only" state):
3944 <example compact="compact">
3945 <var>new-preinst</var> install <var>old-version</var>
3949 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-install <var>old-version</var>
3951 If this fails, the package is left in a
3952 "Half-Installed" state, which requires a
3953 reinstall. If it works, the packages is left in
3954 a "Config-Files" state.
3957 Otherwise (i.e., the package was completely purged):
3958 <example compact="compact">
3959 <var>new-preinst</var> install
3962 <example compact="compact">
3963 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-install
3965 If the error-unwind fails, the package is in a
3966 "Half-Installed" phase, and requires a
3967 reinstall. If the error unwind works, the
3968 package is in a not installed state.
3975 The new package's files are unpacked, overwriting any
3976 that may be on the system already, for example any
3977 from the old version of the same package or from
3978 another package. Backups of the old files are kept
3979 temporarily, and if anything goes wrong the package
3980 management system will attempt to put them back as
3981 part of the error unwind.
3985 It is an error for a package to contain files which
3986 are on the system in another package, unless
3987 <tt>Replaces</tt> is used (see <ref id="replaces">).
3989 The following paragraph is not currently the case:
3990 Currently the <tt>- - force-overwrite</tt> flag is
3991 enabled, downgrading it to a warning, but this may not
3997 It is a more serious error for a package to contain a
3998 plain file or other kind of non-directory where another
3999 package has a directory (again, unless
4000 <tt>Replaces</tt> is used). This error can be
4001 overridden if desired using
4002 <tt>--force-overwrite-dir</tt>, but this is not
4007 Packages which overwrite each other's files produce
4008 behavior which, though deterministic, is hard for the
4009 system administrator to understand. It can easily
4010 lead to "missing" programs if, for example, a package
4011 is installed which overwrites a file from another
4012 package, and is then removed again.<footnote>
4013 Part of the problem is due to what is arguably a
4014 bug in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>.
4019 A directory will never be replaced by a symbolic link
4020 to a directory or vice versa; instead, the existing
4021 state (symlink or not) will be left alone and
4022 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will follow the symlink if there is
4031 If the package is being upgraded, call
4032 <example compact="compact">
4033 <var>old-postrm</var> upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4037 If this fails, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will attempt:
4038 <example compact="compact">
4039 <var>new-postrm</var> failed-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
4041 If this works, installation continues. If not,
4043 <example compact="compact">
4044 <var>old-preinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4046 If this fails, the old version is left in a
4047 "Half-Installed" state. If it works, dpkg now
4049 <example compact="compact">
4050 <var>new-postrm</var> abort-upgrade <var>old-version</var>
4052 If this fails, the old version is left in a
4053 "Half-Installed" state. If it works, dpkg now
4055 <example compact="compact">
4056 <var>old-postinst</var> abort-upgrade <var>new-version</var>
4058 If this fails, the old version is in an
4065 This is the point of no return - if
4066 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> gets this far, it won't back off
4067 past this point if an error occurs. This will
4068 leave the package in a fairly bad state, which
4069 will require a successful re-installation to clear
4070 up, but it's when <prgn>dpkg</prgn> starts doing
4071 things that are irreversible.
4076 Any files which were in the old version of the package
4077 but not in the new are removed.
4081 The new file list replaces the old.
4085 The new maintainer scripts replace the old.
4089 Any packages all of whose files have been overwritten
4090 during the installation, and which aren't required for
4091 dependencies, are considered to have been removed.
4092 For each such package
4095 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> calls:
4096 <example compact="compact">
4097 <var>disappearer's-postrm</var> disappear \
4098 <var>overwriter</var> <var>overwriter-version</var>
4102 The package's maintainer scripts are removed.
4105 It is noted in the status database as being in a
4106 sane state, namely not installed (any conffiles
4107 it may have are ignored, rather than being
4108 removed by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>). Note that
4109 disappearing packages do not have their prerm
4110 called, because <prgn>dpkg</prgn> doesn't know
4111 in advance that the package is going to
4118 Any files in the package we're unpacking that are also
4119 listed in the file lists of other packages are removed
4120 from those lists. (This will lobotomize the file list
4121 of the "conflicting" package if there is one.)
4125 The backup files made during installation, above, are
4131 The new package's status is now sane, and recorded as
4136 Here is another point of no return - if the
4137 conflicting package's removal fails we do not unwind
4138 the rest of the installation; the conflicting package
4139 is left in a half-removed limbo.
4144 If there was a conflicting package we go and do the
4145 removal actions (described below), starting with the
4146 removal of the conflicting package's files (any that
4147 are also in the package being installed have already
4148 been removed from the conflicting package's file list,
4149 and so do not get removed now).
4155 <sect id="configdetails"><heading>Details of configuration</heading>
4158 When we configure a package (this happens with <tt>dpkg
4159 --install</tt> and <tt>dpkg --configure</tt>), we first
4160 update any <tt>conffile</tt>s and then call:
4161 <example compact="compact">
4162 <var>postinst</var> configure <var>most-recently-configured-version</var>
4167 No attempt is made to unwind after errors during
4168 configuration. If the configuration fails, the package is in
4169 a "Failed Config" state, and an error message is generated.
4173 If there is no most recently configured version
4174 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will pass a null argument.
4177 Historical note: Truly ancient (pre-1997) versions of
4178 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> passed <tt><unknown></tt>
4179 (including the angle brackets) in this case. Even older
4180 ones did not pass a second argument at all, under any
4181 circumstance. Note that upgrades using such an old dpkg
4182 version are unlikely to work for other reasons, even if
4183 this old argument behavior is handled by your postinst script.
4189 <sect id="removedetails"><heading>Details of removal and/or
4190 configuration purging</heading>
4196 <example compact="compact">
4197 <var>prerm</var> remove
4201 If prerm fails during replacement due to conflict
4203 <var>conflictor's-postinst</var> abort-remove \
4204 in-favour <var>package</var> <var>new-version</var>
4208 <var>postinst</var> abort-remove
4212 If this fails, the package is in a "Half-Configured"
4213 state, or else it remains "Installed".
4217 The package's files are removed (except <tt>conffile</tt>s).
4220 <example compact="compact">
4221 <var>postrm</var> remove
4225 If it fails, there's no error unwind, and the package is in
4226 an "Half-Installed" state.
4231 All the maintainer scripts except the <prgn>postrm</prgn>
4236 If we aren't purging the package we stop here. Note
4237 that packages which have no <prgn>postrm</prgn> and no
4238 <tt>conffile</tt>s are automatically purged when
4239 removed, as there is no difference except for the
4240 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> status.
4244 The <tt>conffile</tt>s and any backup files
4245 (<tt>~</tt>-files, <tt>#*#</tt> files,
4246 <tt>%</tt>-files, <tt>.dpkg-{old,new,tmp}</tt>, etc.)
4251 <example compact="compact">
4252 <var>postrm</var> purge
4256 If this fails, the package remains in a "Config-Files"
4261 The package's file list is removed.
4270 <chapt id="relationships">
4271 <heading>Declaring relationships between packages</heading>
4273 <sect id="depsyntax">
4274 <heading>Syntax of relationship fields</heading>
4277 These fields all have a uniform syntax. They are a list of
4278 package names separated by commas.
4282 In the <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Recommends</tt>,
4283 <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
4284 <tt>Build-Depends</tt> and <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>
4285 control file fields of the package, which declare
4286 dependencies on other packages, the package names listed may
4287 also include lists of alternative package names, separated
4288 by vertical bar (pipe) symbols <tt>|</tt>. In such a case,
4289 if any one of the alternative packages is installed, that
4290 part of the dependency is considered to be satisfied.
4294 All of the fields except for <tt>Provides</tt> may restrict
4295 their applicability to particular versions of each named
4296 package. This is done in parentheses after each individual
4297 package name; the parentheses should contain a relation from
4298 the list below followed by a version number, in the format
4299 described in <ref id="f-Version">.
4303 The relations allowed are <tt><<</tt>, <tt><=</tt>,
4304 <tt>=</tt>, <tt>>=</tt> and <tt>>></tt> for
4305 strictly earlier, earlier or equal, exactly equal, later or
4306 equal and strictly later, respectively. The deprecated
4307 forms <tt><</tt> and <tt>></tt> were used to mean
4308 earlier/later or equal, rather than strictly earlier/later,
4309 so they should not appear in new packages (though
4310 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> still supports them).
4314 Whitespace may appear at any point in the version
4315 specification subject to the rules in <ref
4316 id="controlsyntax">, and must appear where it's necessary to
4317 disambiguate; it is not otherwise significant. All of the
4318 relationship fields may span multiple lines. For
4319 consistency and in case of future changes to
4320 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> it is recommended that a single space be
4321 used after a version relationship and before a version
4322 number; it is also conventional to put a single space after
4323 each comma, on either side of each vertical bar, and before
4324 each open parenthesis. When wrapping a relationship field, it
4325 is conventional to do so after a comma and before the space
4326 following that comma.
4330 For example, a list of dependencies might appear as:
4331 <example compact="compact">
4334 Depends: libc6 (>= 2.2.1), exim | mail-transport-agent
4339 All fields that specify build-time relationships
4340 (<tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4341 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>)
4342 may be restricted to a certain set of architectures. This
4343 is indicated in brackets after each individual package name and
4344 the optional version specification. The brackets enclose a
4345 list of Debian architecture names separated by whitespace.
4346 Exclamation marks may be prepended to each of the names.
4347 (It is not permitted for some names to be prepended with
4348 exclamation marks while others aren't.) If the current Debian
4349 host architecture is not in this list and there are no
4350 exclamation marks in the list, or it is in the list with a
4351 prepended exclamation mark, the package name and the
4352 associated version specification are ignored completely for
4353 the purposes of defining the relationships.
4358 <example compact="compact">
4360 Build-Depends-Indep: texinfo
4361 Build-Depends: kernel-headers-2.2.10 [!hurd-i386],
4362 hurd-dev [hurd-i386], gnumach-dev [hurd-i386]
4364 requires <tt>kernel-headers-2.2.10</tt> on all architectures
4365 other than hurd-i386 and requires <tt>hurd-dev</tt> and
4366 <tt>gnumach-dev</tt> only on hurd-i386.
4370 If the architecture-restricted dependency is part of a set of
4371 alternatives using <tt>|</tt>, that alternative is ignored
4372 completely on architectures that do not match the restriction.
4374 <example compact="compact">
4375 Build-Depends: foo [!i386] | bar [!amd64]
4377 is equivalent to <tt>bar</tt> on the i386 architecture, to
4378 <tt>foo</tt> on the amd64 architecture, and to <tt>foo |
4379 bar</tt> on all other architectures.
4383 All fields that specify build-time relationships may also be
4384 restricted to a certain set of architectures using architecture
4385 wildcards. The syntax for declaring such restrictions is the
4386 same as declaring restrictions using a certain set of
4387 architectures without architecture wildcards. For example:
4388 <example compact="compact">
4389 Build-Depends: foo [linux-any], bar [any-i386], baz [!linux-any]
4391 is equivalent to <tt>foo</tt> on architectures using the Linux
4392 kernel and any cpu, <tt>bar</tt> on architectures using any
4393 kernel and an i386 cpu, and <tt>baz</tt> on any architecture
4394 using a kernel other than Linux.
4398 Note that the binary package relationship fields such as
4399 <tt>Depends</tt> appear in one of the binary package
4400 sections of the control file, whereas the build-time
4401 relationships such as <tt>Build-Depends</tt> appear in the
4402 source package section of the control file (which is the
4407 <sect id="binarydeps">
4408 <heading>Binary Dependencies - <tt>Depends</tt>,
4409 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4410 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>
4414 Packages can declare in their control file that they have
4415 certain relationships to other packages - for example, that
4416 they may not be installed at the same time as certain other
4417 packages, and/or that they depend on the presence of others.
4421 This is done using the <tt>Depends</tt>, <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>,
4422 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4423 <tt>Breaks</tt> and <tt>Conflicts</tt> control file fields.
4424 <tt>Breaks</tt> is described in <ref id="breaks">, and
4425 <tt>Conflicts</tt> is described in <ref id="conflicts">. The
4426 rest are described below.
4430 These seven fields are used to declare a dependency
4431 relationship by one package on another. Except for
4432 <tt>Enhances</tt> and <tt>Breaks</tt>, they appear in the
4433 depending (binary) package's control file.
4434 (<tt>Enhances</tt> appears in the recommending package's
4435 control file, and <tt>Breaks</tt> appears in the version of
4436 depended-on package which causes the named package to
4441 A <tt>Depends</tt> field takes effect <em>only</em> when a
4442 package is to be configured. It does not prevent a package
4443 being on the system in an unconfigured state while its
4444 dependencies are unsatisfied, and it is possible to replace
4445 a package whose dependencies are satisfied and which is
4446 properly installed with a different version whose
4447 dependencies are not and cannot be satisfied; when this is
4448 done the depending package will be left unconfigured (since
4449 attempts to configure it will give errors) and will not
4450 function properly. If it is necessary, a
4451 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> field can be used, which has a partial
4452 effect even when a package is being unpacked, as explained
4453 in detail below. (The other three dependency fields,
4454 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt> and
4455 <tt>Enhances</tt>, are only used by the various front-ends
4456 to <prgn>dpkg</prgn> such as <prgn>apt-get</prgn>,
4457 <prgn>aptitude</prgn>, and <prgn>dselect</prgn>.)
4461 For this reason packages in an installation run are usually
4462 all unpacked first and all configured later; this gives
4463 later versions of packages with dependencies on later
4464 versions of other packages the opportunity to have their
4465 dependencies satisfied.
4469 In case of circular dependencies, since installation or
4470 removal order honoring the dependency order can't be
4471 established, dependency loops are broken at some point
4472 (based on rules below), and some packages may not be able to
4473 rely on their dependencies being present when being
4474 installed or removed, depending on which side of the break
4475 of the circular dependency loop they happen to be on. If one
4476 of the packages in the loop has no postinst script, then the
4477 cycle will be broken at that package, so as to ensure that
4478 all postinst scripts run with the dependencies properly
4479 configured if this is possible. Otherwise the breaking point
4484 The <tt>Depends</tt> field thus allows package maintainers
4485 to impose an order in which packages should be configured.
4489 The meaning of the five dependency fields is as follows:
4491 <tag><tt>Depends</tt></tag>
4494 This declares an absolute dependency. A package will
4495 not be configured unless all of the packages listed in
4496 its <tt>Depends</tt> field have been correctly
4501 The <tt>Depends</tt> field should be used if the
4502 depended-on package is required for the depending
4503 package to provide a significant amount of
4508 The <tt>Depends</tt> field should also be used if the
4509 <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn> or
4510 <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts require the package to be
4511 present in order to run. Note, however, that the
4512 <prgn>postrm</prgn> cannot rely on any non-essential
4513 packages to be present during the <tt>purge</tt>
4517 <tag><tt>Recommends</tt></tag>
4520 This declares a strong, but not absolute, dependency.
4524 The <tt>Recommends</tt> field should list packages
4525 that would be found together with this one in all but
4526 unusual installations.
4530 <tag><tt>Suggests</tt></tag>
4532 This is used to declare that one package may be more
4533 useful with one or more others. Using this field
4534 tells the packaging system and the user that the
4535 listed packages are related to this one and can
4536 perhaps enhance its usefulness, but that installing
4537 this one without them is perfectly reasonable.
4540 <tag><tt>Enhances</tt></tag>
4542 This field is similar to Suggests but works in the
4543 opposite direction. It is used to declare that a
4544 package can enhance the functionality of another
4548 <tag><tt>Pre-Depends</tt></tag>
4551 This field is like <tt>Depends</tt>, except that it
4552 also forces <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to complete installation
4553 of the packages named before even starting the
4554 installation of the package which declares the
4555 pre-dependency, as follows:
4559 When a package declaring a pre-dependency is about to
4560 be <em>unpacked</em> the pre-dependency can be
4561 satisfied if the depended-on package is either fully
4562 configured, <em>or even if</em> the depended-on
4563 package(s) are only unpacked or in the "Half-Configured"
4564 state, provided that they have been configured
4565 correctly at some point in the past (and not removed
4566 or partially removed since). In this case, both the
4567 previously-configured and currently unpacked or
4568 "Half-Configured" versions must satisfy any version
4569 clause in the <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> field.
4573 When the package declaring a pre-dependency is about
4574 to be <em>configured</em>, the pre-dependency will be
4575 treated as a normal <tt>Depends</tt>, that is, it will
4576 be considered satisfied only if the depended-on
4577 package has been correctly configured.
4581 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> should be used sparingly,
4582 preferably only by packages whose premature upgrade or
4583 installation would hamper the ability of the system to
4584 continue with any upgrade that might be in progress.
4588 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt> are also required if the
4589 <prgn>preinst</prgn> script depends on the named
4590 package. It is best to avoid this situation if
4598 When selecting which level of dependency to use you should
4599 consider how important the depended-on package is to the
4600 functionality of the one declaring the dependency. Some
4601 packages are composed of components of varying degrees of
4602 importance. Such a package should list using
4603 <tt>Depends</tt> the package(s) which are required by the
4604 more important components. The other components'
4605 requirements may be mentioned as Suggestions or
4606 Recommendations, as appropriate to the components' relative
4612 <heading>Packages which break other packages - <tt>Breaks</tt></heading>
4615 When one binary package declares that it breaks another,
4616 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will refuse to allow the package which
4617 declares <tt>Breaks</tt> be installed unless the broken
4618 package is deconfigured first, and it will refuse to
4619 allow the broken package to be reconfigured.
4623 A package will not be regarded as causing breakage merely
4624 because its configuration files are still installed; it must
4625 be at least "Half-Installed".
4629 A special exception is made for packages which declare that
4630 they break their own package name or a virtual package which
4631 they provide (see below): this does not count as a real
4636 Normally a <tt>Breaks</tt> entry will have an "earlier than"
4637 version clause; such a <tt>Breaks</tt> is introduced in the
4638 version of an (implicit or explicit) dependency which
4639 violates an assumption or reveals a bug in earlier versions
4640 of the broken package. This use of <tt>Breaks</tt> will
4641 inform higher-level package management tools that broken
4642 package must be upgraded before the new one.
4646 If the breaking package also overwrites some files from the
4647 older package, it should use <tt>Replaces</tt> (not
4648 <tt>Conflicts</tt>) to ensure this goes smoothly.
4652 <sect id="conflicts">
4653 <heading>Conflicting binary packages - <tt>Conflicts</tt></heading>
4656 When one binary package declares a conflict with another
4657 using a <tt>Conflicts</tt> field, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will
4658 refuse to allow them to be installed on the system at the
4663 If one package is to be installed, the other must be removed
4664 first - if the package being installed is marked as
4665 replacing (see <ref id="replaces">) the one on the system,
4666 or the one on the system is marked as deselected, or both
4667 packages are marked <tt>Essential</tt>, then
4668 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will automatically remove the package
4669 which is causing the conflict, otherwise it will halt the
4670 installation of the new package with an error. This
4671 mechanism is specifically designed to produce an error when
4672 the installed package is <tt>Essential</tt>, but the new
4677 A package will not cause a conflict merely because its
4678 configuration files are still installed; it must be at least
4683 A special exception is made for packages which declare a
4684 conflict with their own package name, or with a virtual
4685 package which they provide (see below): this does not
4686 prevent their installation, and allows a package to conflict
4687 with others providing a replacement for it. You use this
4688 feature when you want the package in question to be the only
4689 package providing some feature.
4693 A <tt>Conflicts</tt> entry should almost never have an
4694 "earlier than" version clause. This would prevent
4695 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> from upgrading or installing the package
4696 which declared such a conflict until the upgrade or removal
4697 of the conflicted-with package had been completed. Instead,
4698 <tt>Breaks</tt> may be used.
4702 <sect id="virtual"><heading>Virtual packages - <tt>Provides</tt>
4706 As well as the names of actual ("concrete") packages, the
4707 package relationship fields <tt>Depends</tt>,
4708 <tt>Recommends</tt>, <tt>Suggests</tt>, <tt>Enhances</tt>,
4709 <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>, <tt>Breaks</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt>,
4710 <tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4711 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>
4712 may mention "virtual packages".
4716 A <em>virtual package</em> is one which appears in the
4717 <tt>Provides</tt> control file field of another package.
4718 The effect is as if the package(s) which provide a
4719 particular virtual package name had been listed by name
4720 everywhere the virtual package name appears. (See also <ref
4725 If there are both concrete and virtual packages of the same
4726 name, then the dependency may be satisfied (or the conflict
4727 caused) by either the concrete package with the name in
4728 question or any other concrete package which provides the
4729 virtual package with the name in question. This is so that,
4730 for example, supposing we have
4731 <example compact="compact">
4734 </example> and someone else releases an enhanced version of
4735 the <tt>bar</tt> package they can say:
4736 <example compact="compact">
4740 and the <tt>bar-plus</tt> package will now also satisfy the
4741 dependency for the <tt>foo</tt> package.
4745 If a relationship field has a version number attached
4746 then only real packages will be considered to see whether
4747 the relationship is satisfied (or the prohibition violated,
4748 for a conflict or breakage) - it is assumed that a real
4749 package which provides the virtual package is not of the
4750 "right" version. So, a <tt>Provides</tt> field may not
4751 contain version numbers, and the version number of the
4752 concrete package which provides a particular virtual package
4753 will not be looked at when considering a dependency on or
4754 conflict with the virtual package name.
4758 It is likely that the ability will be added in a future
4759 release of <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to specify a version number for
4760 each virtual package it provides. This feature is not yet
4761 present, however, and is expected to be used only
4766 If you want to specify which of a set of real packages
4767 should be the default to satisfy a particular dependency on
4768 a virtual package, you should list the real package as an
4769 alternative before the virtual one.
4774 <sect id="replaces"><heading>Overwriting files and replacing
4775 packages - <tt>Replaces</tt></heading>
4778 Packages can declare in their control file that they should
4779 overwrite files in certain other packages, or completely
4780 replace other packages. The <tt>Replaces</tt> control file
4781 field has these two distinct purposes.
4784 <sect1><heading>Overwriting files in other packages</heading>
4787 Firstly, as mentioned before, it is usually an error for a
4788 package to contain files which are on the system in
4793 However, if the overwriting package declares that it
4794 <tt>Replaces</tt> the one containing the file being
4795 overwritten, then <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will replace the file
4796 from the old package with that from the new. The file
4797 will no longer be listed as "owned" by the old package.
4801 For example, if a package <package>foo</package> is split
4802 into <package>foo</package> and <package>foo-data</package>
4803 starting at version 1.2-3, <package>foo-data</package> should
4805 <example compact="compact">
4806 Replaces: foo (<< 1.2-3)
4808 in its control file. The package <package>foo</package>
4809 doesn't need any special control fields in this example,
4810 although would generally depend on or
4811 recommend <package>foo-data</package>.
4815 If a package is completely replaced in this way, so that
4816 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> does not know of any files it still
4817 contains, it is considered to have "disappeared". It will
4818 be marked as not wanted on the system (selected for
4819 removal) and not installed. Any <tt>conffile</tt>s
4820 details noted for the package will be ignored, as they
4821 will have been taken over by the overwriting package. The
4822 package's <prgn>postrm</prgn> script will be run with a
4823 special argument to allow the package to do any final
4824 cleanup required. See <ref id="mscriptsinstact">.
4827 Replaces is a one way relationship -- you have to
4828 install the replacing package after the replaced
4835 For this usage of <tt>Replaces</tt>, virtual packages (see
4836 <ref id="virtual">) are not considered when looking at a
4837 <tt>Replaces</tt> field - the packages declared as being
4838 replaced must be mentioned by their real names.
4842 Furthermore, this usage of <tt>Replaces</tt> only takes
4843 effect when both packages are at least partially on the
4844 system at once, so that it can only happen if they do not
4845 conflict or if the conflict has been overridden.
4850 <sect1><heading>Replacing whole packages, forcing their
4854 Secondly, <tt>Replaces</tt> allows the packaging system to
4855 resolve which package should be removed when there is a
4856 conflict - see <ref id="conflicts">. This usage only
4857 takes effect when the two packages <em>do</em> conflict,
4858 so that the two usages of this field do not interfere with
4863 In this situation, the package declared as being replaced
4864 can be a virtual package, so for example, all mail
4865 transport agents (MTAs) would have the following fields in
4866 their control files:
4867 <example compact="compact">
4868 Provides: mail-transport-agent
4869 Conflicts: mail-transport-agent
4870 Replaces: mail-transport-agent
4872 ensuring that only one MTA can be installed at any one
4877 <sect id="sourcebinarydeps">
4878 <heading>Relationships between source and binary packages -
4879 <tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>,
4880 <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt>
4884 Source packages that require certain binary packages to be
4885 installed or absent at the time of building the package
4886 can declare relationships to those binary packages.
4890 This is done using the <tt>Build-Depends</tt>,
4891 <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt> and
4892 <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt> control file fields.
4896 Build-dependencies on "build-essential" binary packages can be
4897 omitted. Please see <ref id="pkg-relations"> for more information.
4901 The dependencies and conflicts they define must be satisfied
4902 (as defined earlier for binary packages) in order to invoke
4903 the targets in <tt>debian/rules</tt>, as follows:<footnote>
4905 There is no Build-Depends-Arch; this role is essentially
4906 met with Build-Depends. Anyone building the
4907 <tt>build-indep</tt> and binary-indep<tt></tt> targets is
4908 assumed to be building the whole package, and therefore
4909 installation of all build dependencies is required.
4912 The autobuilders use <tt>dpkg-buildpackage -B</tt>, which
4913 calls <tt>build</tt>, not <tt>build-arch</tt> since it does
4914 not yet know how to check for its existence, and
4915 <tt>binary-arch</tt>. The purpose of the original split
4916 between <tt>Build-Depends</tt> and
4917 <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt> was so that the autobuilders
4918 wouldn't need to install extra packages needed only for the
4919 binary-indep targets. But without a build-arch/build-indep
4920 split, this didn't work, since most of the work is done in
4921 the build target, not in the binary target.
4925 <tag><tt>clean</tt>, <tt>build-arch</tt>, and
4926 <tt>binary-arch</tt></tag>
4928 Only the <tt>Build-Depends</tt> and <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt>
4929 fields must be satisfied when these targets are invoked.
4931 <tag><tt>build</tt>, <tt>build-indep</tt>, <tt>binary</tt>,
4932 and <tt>binary-indep</tt></tag>
4934 The <tt>Build-Depends</tt>, <tt>Build-Conflicts</tt>,
4935 <tt>Build-Depends-Indep</tt>, and
4936 <tt>Build-Conflicts-Indep</tt> fields must be satisfied when
4937 these targets are invoked.
4945 <chapt id="sharedlibs"><heading>Shared libraries</heading>
4948 Packages containing shared libraries must be constructed with
4949 a little care to make sure that the shared library is always
4950 available. This is especially important for packages whose
4951 shared libraries are vitally important, such as the C library
4952 (currently <tt>libc6</tt>).
4956 Packages involving shared libraries should be split up into
4957 several binary packages. This section mostly deals with how
4958 this separation is to be accomplished; rules for files within
4959 the shared library packages are in <ref id="libraries"> instead.
4962 <sect id="sharedlibs-runtime">
4963 <heading>Run-time shared libraries</heading>
4966 The run-time shared library needs to be placed in a package
4967 whose name changes whenever the shared object version
4970 Since it is common place to install several versions of a
4971 package that just provides shared libraries, it is a
4972 good idea that the library package should not
4973 contain any extraneous non-versioned files, unless they
4974 happen to be in versioned directories.</p>
4976 The most common mechanism is to place it in a package
4978 <package><var>libraryname</var><var>soversion</var></package>,
4979 where <file><var>soversion</var></file> is the version number
4980 in the soname of the shared library<footnote>
4981 The soname is the shared object name: it's the thing
4982 that has to match exactly between building an executable
4983 and running it for the dynamic linker to be able run the
4984 program. For example, if the soname of the library is
4985 <file>libfoo.so.6</file>, the library package would be
4986 called <file>libfoo6</file>.
4988 Alternatively, if it would be confusing to directly append
4989 <var>soversion</var> to <var>libraryname</var> (e.g. because
4990 <var>libraryname</var> itself ends in a number), you may use
4991 <package><var>libraryname</var>-<var>soversion</var></package> and
4992 <package><var>libraryname</var>-<var>soversion</var>-dev</package>
4997 If you have several shared libraries built from the same
4998 source tree you may lump them all together into a single
4999 shared library package, provided that you change all of
5000 their sonames at once (so that you don't get filename
5001 clashes if you try to install different versions of the
5002 combined shared libraries package).
5006 The package should install the shared libraries under
5007 their normal names. For example, the <package>libgdbm3</package>
5008 package should install <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file> as
5009 <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. The files should not be
5010 renamed or re-linked by any <prgn>prerm</prgn> or
5011 <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts; <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will take care
5012 of renaming things safely without affecting running programs,
5013 and attempts to interfere with this are likely to lead to
5018 Shared libraries should not be installed executable, since
5019 the dynamic linker does not require this and trying to
5020 execute a shared library usually results in a core dump.
5024 The run-time library package should include the symbolic link that
5025 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> would create for the shared libraries.
5026 For example, the <package>libgdbm3</package> package should include
5027 a symbolic link from <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so.3</file> to
5028 <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. This is needed so that the dynamic
5029 linker (for example <prgn>ld.so</prgn> or
5030 <prgn>ld-linux.so.*</prgn>) can find the library between the
5031 time that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> installs it and the time that
5032 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> is run in the <prgn>postinst</prgn>
5034 The package management system requires the library to be
5035 placed before the symbolic link pointing to it in the
5036 <file>.deb</file> file. This is so that when
5037 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> comes to install the symlink
5038 (overwriting the previous symlink pointing at an older
5039 version of the library), the new shared library is already
5040 in place. In the past, this was achieved by creating the
5041 library in the temporary packaging directory before
5042 creating the symlink. Unfortunately, this was not always
5043 effective, since the building of the tar file in the
5044 <file>.deb</file> depended on the behavior of the underlying
5045 file system. Some file systems (such as reiserfs) reorder
5046 the files so that the order of creation is forgotten.
5047 Since version 1.7.0, <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
5048 reorders the files itself as necessary when building a
5049 package. Thus it is no longer important to concern
5050 oneself with the order of file creation.
5054 <sect1 id="ldconfig">
5055 <heading><tt>ldconfig</tt></heading>
5058 Any package installing shared libraries in one of the default
5059 library directories of the dynamic linker (which are currently
5060 <file>/usr/lib</file> and <file>/lib</file>) or a directory that is
5061 listed in <file>/etc/ld.so.conf</file><footnote>
5063 <list compact="compact">
5064 <item>/usr/local/lib</item>
5065 <item>/usr/lib/libc5-compat</item>
5066 <item>/lib/libc5-compat</item>
5069 must use <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> to update the shared library
5074 The package maintainer scripts must only call
5075 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> under these circumstances:
5076 <list compact="compact">
5077 <item>When the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script is run with a
5078 first argument of <tt>configure</tt>, the script must call
5079 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>, and may optionally invoke
5080 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn> at other times.
5082 <item>When the <prgn>postrm</prgn> script is run with a
5083 first argument of <tt>remove</tt>, the script should call
5084 <prgn>ldconfig</prgn>.
5089 During install or upgrade, the preinst is called before
5090 the new files are installed, so calling "ldconfig" is
5091 pointless. The preinst of an existing package can also be
5092 called if an upgrade fails. However, this happens during
5093 the critical time when a shared libs may exist on-disk
5094 under a temporary name. Thus, it is dangerous and
5095 forbidden by current policy to call "ldconfig" at this
5100 When a package is installed or upgraded, "postinst
5101 configure" runs after the new files are safely on-disk.
5102 Since it is perfectly safe to invoke ldconfig
5103 unconditionally in a postinst, it is OK for a package to
5104 simply put ldconfig in its postinst without checking the
5105 argument. The postinst can also be called to recover from
5106 a failed upgrade. This happens before any new files are
5107 unpacked, so there is no reason to call "ldconfig" at this
5112 For a package that is being removed, prerm is
5113 called with all the files intact, so calling ldconfig is
5114 useless. The other calls to "prerm" happen in the case of
5115 upgrade at a time when all the files of the old package
5116 are on-disk, so again calling "ldconfig" is pointless.
5120 postrm, on the other hand, is called with the "remove"
5121 argument just after the files are removed, so this is
5122 the proper time to call "ldconfig" to notify the system
5123 of the fact that the shared libraries from the package
5124 are removed. The postrm can be called at several other
5125 times. At the time of "postrm purge", "postrm
5126 abort-install", or "postrm abort-upgrade", calling
5127 "ldconfig" is useless because the shared lib files are
5128 not on-disk. However, when "postrm" is invoked with
5129 arguments "upgrade", "failed-upgrade", or "disappear", a
5130 shared lib may exist on-disk under a temporary filename.
5138 <sect id="sharedlibs-support-files">
5139 <heading>Shared library support files</heading>
5142 If your package contains files whose names do not change with
5143 each change in the library shared object version, you must not
5144 put them in the shared library package. Otherwise, several
5145 versions of the shared library cannot be installed at the same
5146 time without filename clashes, making upgrades and transitions
5147 unnecessarily difficult.
5151 It is recommended that supporting files and run-time support
5152 programs that do not need to be invoked manually by users, but
5153 are nevertheless required for the package to function, be placed
5154 (if they are binary) in a subdirectory of <file>/usr/lib</file>,
5155 preferably under <file>/usr/lib/</file><var>package-name</var>.
5156 If the program or file is architecture independent, the
5157 recommendation is for it to be placed in a subdirectory of
5158 <file>/usr/share</file> instead, preferably under
5159 <file>/usr/share/</file><var>package-name</var>. Following the
5160 <var>package-name</var> naming convention ensures that the file
5161 names change when the shared object version changes.
5165 Run-time support programs that use the shared library but are
5166 not required for the library to function or files used by the
5167 shared library that can be used by any version of the shared
5168 library package should instead be put in a separate package.
5169 This package might typically be named
5170 <package><var>libraryname</var>-tools</package>; note the
5171 absence of the <var>soversion</var> in the package name.
5175 Files and support programs only useful when compiling software
5176 against the library should be included in the development
5177 package for the library.<footnote>
5178 For example, a <file><var>package-name</var>-config</file>
5179 script or <package>pkg-config</package> configuration files.
5184 <sect id="sharedlibs-static">
5185 <heading>Static libraries</heading>
5188 The static library (<file><var>libraryname.a</var></file>)
5189 is usually provided in addition to the shared version.
5190 It is placed into the development package (see below).
5194 In some cases, it is acceptable for a library to be
5195 available in static form only; these cases include:
5197 <item>libraries for languages whose shared library support
5198 is immature or unstable</item>
5199 <item>libraries whose interfaces are in flux or under
5200 development (commonly the case when the library's
5201 major version number is zero, or where the ABI breaks
5202 across patchlevels)</item>
5203 <item>libraries which are explicitly intended to be
5204 available only in static form by their upstream
5209 <sect id="sharedlibs-dev">
5210 <heading>Development files</heading>
5213 The development files associated to a shared library need to be
5214 placed in a package called
5215 <package><var>libraryname</var><var>soversion</var>-dev</package>,
5216 or if you prefer only to support one development version at a
5217 time, <package><var>libraryname</var>-dev</package>.
5221 In case several development versions of a library exist, you may
5222 need to use <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s Conflicts mechanism (see
5223 <ref id="conflicts">) to ensure that the user only installs one
5224 development version at a time (as different development versions are
5225 likely to have the same header files in them, which would cause a
5226 filename clash if both were installed).
5230 The development package should contain a symlink for the associated
5231 shared library without a version number. For example, the
5232 <package>libgdbm-dev</package> package should include a symlink
5233 from <file>/usr/lib/libgdbm.so</file> to
5234 <file>libgdbm.so.3.0.0</file>. This symlink is needed by the linker
5235 (<prgn>ld</prgn>) when compiling packages, as it will only look for
5236 <file>libgdbm.so</file> when compiling dynamically.
5240 <sect id="sharedlibs-intradeps">
5241 <heading>Dependencies between the packages of the same library</heading>
5244 Typically the development version should have an exact
5245 version dependency on the runtime library, to make sure that
5246 compilation and linking happens correctly. The
5247 <tt>${binary:Version}</tt> substitution variable can be
5248 useful for this purpose.
5250 Previously, <tt>${Source-Version}</tt> was used, but its name
5251 was confusing and it has been deprecated since dpkg 1.13.19.
5256 <sect id="sharedlibs-shlibdeps">
5257 <heading>Dependencies between the library and other packages -
5258 the <tt>shlibs</tt> system</heading>
5261 If a package contains a binary or library which links to a
5262 shared library, we must ensure that when the package is
5263 installed on the system, all of the libraries needed are
5264 also installed. This requirement led to the creation of the
5265 <tt>shlibs</tt> system, which is very simple in its design:
5266 any package which <em>provides</em> a shared library also
5267 provides information on the package dependencies required to
5268 ensure the presence of this library, and any package which
5269 <em>uses</em> a shared library uses this information to
5270 determine the dependencies it requires. The files which
5271 contain the mapping from shared libraries to the necessary
5272 dependency information are called <file>shlibs</file> files.
5276 Thus, when a package is built which contains any shared
5277 libraries, it must provide a <file>shlibs</file> file for other
5278 packages to use, and when a package is built which contains
5279 any shared libraries or compiled binaries, it must run
5280 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"><prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn></qref>
5281 on these to determine the libraries used and hence the
5282 dependencies needed by this package.<footnote>
5284 In the past, the shared libraries linked to were
5285 determined by calling <prgn>ldd</prgn>, but now
5286 <prgn>objdump</prgn> is used to do this. The only
5287 change this makes to package building is that
5288 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> must also be run on shared
5289 libraries, whereas in the past this was unnecessary.
5290 The rest of this footnote explains the advantage that
5295 We say that a binary <tt>foo</tt> <em>directly</em> uses
5296 a library <tt>libbar</tt> if it is explicitly linked
5297 with that library (that is, it uses the flag
5298 <tt>-lbar</tt> during the linking stage). Other
5299 libraries that are needed by <tt>libbar</tt> are linked
5300 <em>indirectly</em> to <tt>foo</tt>, and the dynamic
5301 linker will load them automatically when it loads
5302 <tt>libbar</tt>. A package should depend on
5303 the libraries it directly uses, and the dependencies for
5304 those libraries should automatically pull in the other
5309 Unfortunately, the <prgn>ldd</prgn> program shows both
5310 the directly and indirectly used libraries, meaning that
5311 the dependencies determined included both direct and
5312 indirect dependencies. The use of <prgn>objdump</prgn>
5313 avoids this problem by determining only the directly
5318 A good example of where this helps is the following. We
5319 could update <tt>libimlib</tt> with a new version that
5320 supports a new graphics format called dgf (but retaining
5321 the same major version number). If we used the old
5322 <prgn>ldd</prgn> method, every package that uses
5323 <tt>libimlib</tt> would need to be recompiled so it
5324 would also depend on <tt>libdgf</tt> or it wouldn't run
5325 due to missing symbols. However with the new system,
5326 packages using <tt>libimlib</tt> can rely on
5327 <tt>libimlib</tt> itself having the dependency on
5328 <tt>libdgf</tt> and so they would not need rebuilding.
5334 In the following sections, we will first describe where the
5335 various <tt>shlibs</tt> files are to be found, then how to
5336 use <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>, and finally the <tt>shlibs</tt>
5337 file format and how to create them if your package contains a
5342 <heading>The <tt>shlibs</tt> files present on the system</heading>
5345 There are several places where <tt>shlibs</tt> files are
5346 found. The following list gives them in the order in which
5348 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"><prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn></qref>.
5349 (The first one which gives the required information is used.)
5355 <p><file>debian/shlibs.local</file></p>
5358 This lists overrides for this package. Its use is
5359 described below (see <ref id="shlibslocal">).
5364 <p><file>/etc/dpkg/shlibs.override</file></p>
5367 This lists global overrides. This list is normally
5368 empty. It is maintained by the local system
5374 <p><file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files in the "build directory"</p>
5377 When packages are being built, any
5378 <file>debian/shlibs</file> files are copied into the
5379 control file area of the temporary build directory and
5380 given the name <file>shlibs</file>. These files give
5381 details of any shared libraries included in the
5383 An example may help here. Let us say that the
5384 source package <tt>foo</tt> generates two binary
5385 packages, <tt>libfoo2</tt> and
5386 <tt>foo-runtime</tt>. When building the binary
5387 packages, the two packages are created in the
5388 directories <file>debian/libfoo2</file> and
5389 <file>debian/foo-runtime</file> respectively.
5390 (<file>debian/tmp</file> could be used instead of one
5391 of these.) Since <tt>libfoo2</tt> provides the
5392 <tt>libfoo</tt> shared library, it will require a
5393 <tt>shlibs</tt> file, which will be installed in
5394 <file>debian/libfoo2/DEBIAN/shlibs</file>, eventually
5396 <file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/libfoo2.shlibs</file>. Then
5397 when <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> is run on the
5399 <file>debian/foo-runtime/usr/bin/foo-prog</file>, it
5401 <file>debian/libfoo2/DEBIAN/shlibs</file> file to
5402 determine whether <tt>foo-prog</tt>'s library
5403 dependencies are satisfied by any of the libraries
5404 provided by <tt>libfoo2</tt>. For this reason,
5405 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> must only be run once
5406 all of the individual binary packages'
5407 <tt>shlibs</tt> files have been installed into the
5414 <p><file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/*.shlibs</file></p>
5417 These are the <file>shlibs</file> files corresponding to
5418 all of the packages installed on the system, and are
5419 maintained by the relevant package maintainers.
5424 <p><file>/etc/dpkg/shlibs.default</file></p>
5427 This file lists any shared libraries whose packages
5428 have failed to provide correct <file>shlibs</file> files.
5429 It was used when the <file>shlibs</file> setup was first
5430 introduced, but it is now normally empty. It is
5431 maintained by the <tt>dpkg</tt> maintainer.
5439 <heading>How to use <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> and the
5440 <file>shlibs</file> files</heading>
5444 <qref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"><prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn></qref>
5445 into your <file>debian/rules</file> file. If your package
5446 contains only compiled binaries and libraries (but no scripts),
5447 you can use a command such as:
5448 <example compact="compact">
5449 dpkg-shlibdeps debian/tmp/usr/bin/* debian/tmp/usr/sbin/* \
5450 debian/tmp/usr/lib/*
5452 Otherwise, you will need to explicitly list the compiled
5453 binaries and libraries.<footnote>
5454 If you are using <tt>debhelper</tt>, the
5455 <prgn>dh_shlibdeps</prgn> program will do this work for
5456 you. It will also correctly handle multi-binary
5462 This command puts the dependency information into the
5463 <file>debian/substvars</file> file, which is then used by
5464 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>. You will need to place a
5465 <tt>${shlibs:Depends}</tt> variable in the <tt>Depends</tt>
5466 field in the control file for this to work.
5470 If <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> doesn't complain, you're
5471 done. If it does complain you might need to create your own
5472 <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file, as explained below (see
5473 <ref id="shlibslocal">).
5477 If you have multiple binary packages, you will need to call
5478 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> on each one which contains
5479 compiled libraries or binaries. In such a case, you will
5480 need to use the <tt>-T</tt> option to the <tt>dpkg</tt>
5481 utilities to specify a different <file>substvars</file> file.
5485 If you are creating a udeb for use in the Debian Installer,
5486 you will need to specify that <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>
5487 should use the dependency line of type <tt>udeb</tt> by
5488 adding the <tt>-tudeb</tt> option<footnote>
5489 <prgn>dh_shlibdeps</prgn> from the <tt>debhelper</tt> suite
5490 will automatically add this option if it knows it is
5492 </footnote>. If there is no dependency line of type <tt>udeb</tt>
5493 in the <file>shlibs</file> file, <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> will
5494 fall back to the regular dependency line.
5498 For more details on dpkg-shlibdeps, please see
5499 <ref id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps"> and
5500 <manref name="dpkg-shlibdeps" section="1">.
5505 <heading>The <file>shlibs</file> File Format</heading>
5508 Each <file>shlibs</file> file has the same format. Lines
5509 beginning with <tt>#</tt> are considered to be comments and
5510 are ignored. Each line is of the form:
5511 <example compact="compact">
5512 [<var>type</var>: ]<var>library-name</var> <var>soname-version</var> <var>dependencies ...</var>
5517 We will explain this by reference to the example of the
5518 <tt>zlib1g</tt> package, which (at the time of writing)
5519 installs the shared library <file>/usr/lib/libz.so.1.1.3</file>.
5523 <var>type</var> is an optional element that indicates the type
5524 of package for which the line is valid. The only type currently
5525 in use is <tt>udeb</tt>. The colon and space after the type are
5530 <var>library-name</var> is the name of the shared library,
5531 in this case <tt>libz</tt>. (This must match the name part
5532 of the soname, see below.)
5536 <var>soname-version</var> is the version part of the soname of
5537 the library. The soname is the thing that must exactly match
5538 for the library to be recognized by the dynamic linker, and is
5540 <tt><var>name</var>.so.<var>major-version</var></tt>, in our
5541 example, <tt>libz.so.1</tt>.<footnote>
5542 This can be determined using the command
5543 <example compact="compact">
5544 objdump -p /usr/lib/libz.so.1.1.3 | grep SONAME
5547 The version part is the part which comes after
5548 <tt>.so.</tt>, so in our case, it is <tt>1</tt>.
5552 <var>dependencies</var> has the same syntax as a dependency
5553 field in a binary package control file. It should give
5554 details of which packages are required to satisfy a binary
5555 built against the version of the library contained in the
5556 package. See <ref id="depsyntax"> for details.
5560 In our example, if the first version of the <tt>zlib1g</tt>
5561 package which contained a minor number of at least
5562 <tt>1.3</tt> was <var>1:1.1.3-1</var>, then the
5563 <tt>shlibs</tt> entry for this library could say:
5564 <example compact="compact">
5565 libz 1 zlib1g (>= 1:1.1.3)
5567 The version-specific dependency is to avoid warnings from
5568 the dynamic linker about using older shared libraries with
5573 As zlib1g also provides a udeb containing the shared library,
5574 there would also be a second line:
5575 <example compact="compact">
5576 udeb: libz 1 zlib1g-udeb (>= 1:1.1.3)
5582 <heading>Providing a <file>shlibs</file> file</heading>
5585 If your package provides a shared library, you need to create
5586 a <file>shlibs</file> file following the format described above.
5587 It is usual to call this file <file>debian/shlibs</file> (but if
5588 you have multiple binary packages, you might want to call it
5589 <file>debian/shlibs.<var>package</var></file> instead). Then
5590 let <file>debian/rules</file> install it in the control area:
5591 <example compact="compact">
5592 install -m644 debian/shlibs debian/tmp/DEBIAN
5594 or, in the case of a multi-binary package:
5595 <example compact="compact">
5596 install -m644 debian/shlibs.<var>package</var> debian/<var>package</var>/DEBIAN/shlibs
5598 An alternative way of doing this is to create the
5599 <file>shlibs</file> file in the control area directly from
5600 <file>debian/rules</file> without using a <file>debian/shlibs</file>
5601 file at all,<footnote>
5602 This is what <prgn>dh_makeshlibs</prgn> in the
5603 <tt>debhelper</tt> suite does. If your package also has a udeb
5604 that provides a shared library, <prgn>dh_makeshlibs</prgn> can
5605 automatically generate the <tt>udeb:</tt> lines if you specify
5606 the name of the udeb with the <tt>--add-udeb</tt> option.
5608 since the <file>debian/shlibs</file> file itself is ignored by
5609 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>.
5613 As <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> reads the
5614 <file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files in all of the binary packages
5615 being built from this source package, all of the
5616 <file>DEBIAN/shlibs</file> files should be installed before
5617 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> is called on any of the binary
5622 <sect1 id="shlibslocal">
5623 <heading>Writing the <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file</heading>
5626 This file is intended only as a <em>temporary</em> fix if
5627 your binaries or libraries depend on a library whose package
5628 does not yet provide a correct <file>shlibs</file> file.
5632 We will assume that you are trying to package a binary
5633 <tt>foo</tt>. When you try running
5634 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> you get the following error
5635 message (<tt>-O</tt> displays the dependency information on
5636 <tt>stdout</tt> instead of writing it to
5637 <tt>debian/substvars</tt>, and the lines have been wrapped
5638 for ease of reading):
5639 <example compact="compact">
5640 $ dpkg-shlibdeps -O debian/tmp/usr/bin/foo
5641 dpkg-shlibdeps: warning: unable to find dependency
5642 information for shared library libbar (soname 1,
5643 path /usr/lib/libbar.so.1, dependency field Depends)
5644 shlibs:Depends=libc6 (>= 2.2.2-2)
5646 You can then run <prgn>ldd</prgn> on the binary to find the
5647 full location of the library concerned:
5648 <example compact="compact">
5650 libbar.so.1 => /usr/lib/libbar.so.1 (0x4001e000)
5651 libc.so.6 => /lib/libc.so.6 (0x40032000)
5652 /lib/ld-linux.so.2 => /lib/ld-linux.so.2 (0x40000000)
5654 So the <prgn>foo</prgn> binary depends on the
5655 <prgn>libbar</prgn> shared library, but no package seems to
5656 provide a <file>*.shlibs</file> file handling
5657 <file>libbar.so.1</file> in <file>/var/lib/dpkg/info/</file>. Let's
5658 determine the package responsible:
5659 <example compact="compact">
5660 $ dpkg -S /usr/lib/libbar.so.1
5661 bar1: /usr/lib/libbar.so.1
5662 $ dpkg -s bar1 | grep Version
5665 This tells us that the <tt>bar1</tt> package, version 1.0-1,
5666 is the one we are using. Now we can file a bug against the
5667 <tt>bar1</tt> package and create our own
5668 <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> to locally fix the problem.
5669 Including the following line into your
5670 <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file:
5671 <example compact="compact">
5672 libbar 1 bar1 (>= 1.0-1)
5674 should allow the package build to work.
5678 As soon as the maintainer of <tt>bar1</tt> provides a
5679 correct <file>shlibs</file> file, you should remove this line
5680 from your <file>debian/shlibs.local</file> file. (You should
5681 probably also then have a versioned <tt>Build-Depends</tt>
5682 on <tt>bar1</tt> to help ensure that others do not have the
5683 same problem building your package.)
5692 <chapt id="opersys"><heading>The Operating System</heading>
5695 <heading>File system hierarchy</heading>
5699 <heading>File System Structure</heading>
5702 The location of all installed files and directories must
5703 comply with the Filesystem Hierarchy Standard (FHS),
5704 version 2.3, with the exceptions noted below, and except
5705 where doing so would violate other terms of Debian
5706 Policy. The following exceptions to the FHS apply:
5711 The optional rules related to user specific
5712 configuration files for applications are stored in
5713 the user's home directory are relaxed. It is
5714 recommended that such files start with the
5715 '<tt>.</tt>' character (a "dot file"), and if an
5716 application needs to create more than one dot file
5717 then the preferred placement is in a subdirectory
5718 with a name starting with a '.' character, (a "dot
5719 directory"). In this case it is recommended the
5720 configuration files not start with the '.'
5726 The requirement for amd64 to use <file>/lib64</file>
5727 for 64 bit binaries is removed.
5732 The requirement for object files, internal binaries, and
5733 libraries, including <file>libc.so.*</file>, to be located
5734 directly under <file>/lib{,32}</file> and
5735 <file>/usr/lib{,32}</file> is amended, permitting files
5736 to instead be installed to
5737 <file>/lib/<var>triplet</var></file> and
5738 <file>/usr/lib/<var>triplet</var></file>, where
5739 <tt><var>triplet</var></tt> is the value returned by
5740 <tt>dpkg-architecture -qDEB_HOST_GNU_TYPE</tt> for the
5741 architecture of the package. Packages may <em>not</em>
5742 install files to any <var>triplet</var> path other
5743 than the one matching the architecture of that package;
5744 for instance, an <tt>Architecture: amd64</tt> package
5745 containing 32-bit x86 libraries may not install these
5746 libraries to <file>/usr/lib/i486-linux-gnu</file>.
5748 This is necessary in order to reserve the directories for
5749 use in cross-installation of library packages from other
5750 architectures, as part of the planned deployment of
5755 Applications may also use a single subdirectory under
5756 <file>/usr/lib/<var>triplet</var></file>.
5759 The execution time linker/loader, ld*, must still be made
5760 available in the existing location under /lib or /lib64
5761 since this is part of the ELF ABI for the architecture.
5766 The requirement that
5767 <file>/usr/local/share/man</file> be "synonymous"
5768 with <file>/usr/local/man</file> is relaxed to a
5773 The requirement that windowmanagers with a single
5774 configuration file call it <file>system.*wmrc</file>
5775 is removed, as is the restriction that the window
5776 manager subdirectory be named identically to the
5777 window manager name itself.
5782 The requirement that boot manager configuration
5783 files live in <file>/etc</file>, or at least are
5784 symlinked there, is relaxed to a recommendation.
5789 The following directories in the root filesystem are
5790 additionally allowed: <file>/sys</file> and
5791 <file>/selinux</file>. <footnote>These directories
5792 are used as mount points to mount virtual filesystems
5793 to get access to kernel information.</footnote>
5800 The version of this document referred here can be
5801 found in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package or on <url
5802 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/fhs/"
5803 name="FHS (Debian copy)"> alongside this manual (or, if
5804 you have the <package>debian-policy</package> installed,
5806 id="file:///usr/share/doc/debian-policy/fhs/" name="FHS
5807 (local copy)">). The
5808 latest version, which may be a more recent version, may
5810 <url id="http://www.pathname.com/fhs/" name="FHS (upstream)">.
5811 Specific questions about following the standard may be
5812 asked on the <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list, or
5813 referred to the FHS mailing list (see the
5814 <url id="http://www.pathname.com/fhs/" name="FHS web site"> for
5820 <heading>Site-specific programs</heading>
5823 As mandated by the FHS, packages must not place any
5824 files in <file>/usr/local</file>, either by putting them in
5825 the file system archive to be unpacked by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
5826 or by manipulating them in their maintainer scripts.
5830 However, the package may create empty directories below
5831 <file>/usr/local</file> so that the system administrator knows
5832 where to place site-specific files. These are not
5833 directories <em>in</em> <file>/usr/local</file>, but are
5834 children of directories in <file>/usr/local</file>. These
5835 directories (<file>/usr/local/*/dir/</file>)
5836 should be removed on package removal if they are
5841 Note that this applies only to
5842 directories <em>below</em> <file>/usr/local</file>,
5843 not <em>in</em> <file>/usr/local</file>. Packages must
5844 not create sub-directories in the
5845 directory <file>/usr/local</file> itself, except those
5846 listed in FHS, section 4.5. However, you may create
5847 directories below them as you wish. You must not remove
5848 any of the directories listed in 4.5, even if you created
5853 Since <file>/usr/local</file> can be mounted read-only from a
5854 remote server, these directories must be created and
5855 removed by the <prgn>postinst</prgn> and <prgn>prerm</prgn>
5856 maintainer scripts and not be included in the
5857 <file>.deb</file> archive. These scripts must not fail if
5858 either of these operations fail.
5862 For example, the <tt>emacsen-common</tt> package could
5863 contain something like
5864 <example compact="compact">
5865 if [ ! -e /usr/local/share/emacs ]
5867 if mkdir /usr/local/share/emacs 2>/dev/null
5869 chown root:staff /usr/local/share/emacs
5870 chmod 2775 /usr/local/share/emacs
5874 in its <prgn>postinst</prgn> script, and
5875 <example compact="compact">
5876 rmdir /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp 2>/dev/null || true
5877 rmdir /usr/local/share/emacs 2>/dev/null || true
5879 in the <prgn>prerm</prgn> script. (Note that this form is
5880 used to ensure that if the script is interrupted, the
5881 directory <file>/usr/local/share/emacs</file> will still be
5886 If you do create a directory in <file>/usr/local</file> for
5887 local additions to a package, you should ensure that
5888 settings in <file>/usr/local</file> take precedence over the
5889 equivalents in <file>/usr</file>.
5893 However, because <file>/usr/local</file> and its contents are
5894 for exclusive use of the local administrator, a package
5895 must not rely on the presence or absence of files or
5896 directories in <file>/usr/local</file> for normal operation.
5900 The <file>/usr/local</file> directory itself and all the
5901 subdirectories created by the package should (by default) have
5902 permissions 2775 (group-writable and set-group-id) and be
5903 owned by <tt>root:staff</tt>.
5908 <heading>The system-wide mail directory</heading>
5910 The system-wide mail directory
5911 is <file>/var/mail</file>. This directory is part of the
5912 base system and should not be owned by any particular mail
5913 agents. The use of the old
5914 location <file>/var/spool/mail</file> is deprecated, even
5915 though the spool may still be physically located there.
5921 <heading>Users and groups</heading>
5924 <heading>Introduction</heading>
5926 The Debian system can be configured to use either plain or
5931 Some user ids (UIDs) and group ids (GIDs) are reserved
5932 globally for use by certain packages. Because some
5933 packages need to include files which are owned by these
5934 users or groups, or need the ids compiled into binaries,
5935 these ids must be used on any Debian system only for the
5936 purpose for which they are allocated. This is a serious
5937 restriction, and we should avoid getting in the way of
5938 local administration policies. In particular, many sites
5939 allocate users and/or local system groups starting at 100.
5943 Apart from this we should have dynamically allocated ids,
5944 which should by default be arranged in some sensible
5945 order, but the behavior should be configurable.
5949 Packages other than <tt>base-passwd</tt> must not modify
5950 <file>/etc/passwd</file>, <file>/etc/shadow</file>,
5951 <file>/etc/group</file> or <file>/etc/gshadow</file>.
5956 <heading>UID and GID classes</heading>
5958 The UID and GID numbers are divided into classes as
5964 Globally allocated by the Debian project, the same
5965 on every Debian system. These ids will appear in
5966 the <file>passwd</file> and <file>group</file> files of all
5967 Debian systems, new ids in this range being added
5968 automatically as the <tt>base-passwd</tt> package is
5973 Packages which need a single statically allocated
5974 uid or gid should use one of these; their
5975 maintainers should ask the <tt>base-passwd</tt>
5983 Dynamically allocated system users and groups.
5984 Packages which need a user or group, but can have
5985 this user or group allocated dynamically and
5986 differently on each system, should use <tt>adduser
5987 --system</tt> to create the group and/or user.
5988 <prgn>adduser</prgn> will check for the existence of
5989 the user or group, and if necessary choose an unused
5990 id based on the ranges specified in
5991 <file>adduser.conf</file>.
5995 <tag>1000-59999:</tag>
5998 Dynamically allocated user accounts. By default
5999 <prgn>adduser</prgn> will choose UIDs and GIDs for
6000 user accounts in this range, though
6001 <file>adduser.conf</file> may be used to modify this
6006 <tag>60000-64999:</tag>
6009 Globally allocated by the Debian project, but only
6010 created on demand. The ids are allocated centrally
6011 and statically, but the actual accounts are only
6012 created on users' systems on demand.
6016 These ids are for packages which are obscure or
6017 which require many statically-allocated ids. These
6018 packages should check for and create the accounts in
6019 <file>/etc/passwd</file> or <file>/etc/group</file> (using
6020 <prgn>adduser</prgn> if it has this facility) if
6021 necessary. Packages which are likely to require
6022 further allocations should have a "hole" left after
6023 them in the allocation, to give them room to
6028 <tag>65000-65533:</tag>
6036 User <tt>nobody</tt>. The corresponding gid refers
6037 to the group <tt>nogroup</tt>.
6044 <tt>(uid_t)(-1) == (gid_t)(-1)</tt> <em>must
6045 not</em> be used, because it is the error return
6054 <sect id="sysvinit">
6055 <heading>System run levels and <file>init.d</file> scripts</heading>
6057 <sect1 id="/etc/init.d">
6058 <heading>Introduction</heading>
6061 The <file>/etc/init.d</file> directory contains the scripts
6062 executed by <prgn>init</prgn> at boot time and when the
6063 init state (or "runlevel") is changed (see <manref
6064 name="init" section="8">).
6068 There are at least two different, yet functionally
6069 equivalent, ways of handling these scripts. For the sake
6070 of simplicity, this document describes only the symbolic
6071 link method. However, it must not be assumed by maintainer
6072 scripts that this method is being used, and any automated
6073 manipulation of the various runlevel behaviors by
6074 maintainer scripts must be performed using
6075 <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> as described below and not by
6076 manually installing or removing symlinks. For information
6077 on the implementation details of the other method,
6078 implemented in the <tt>file-rc</tt> package, please refer
6079 to the documentation of that package.
6083 These scripts are referenced by symbolic links in the
6084 <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directories. When changing
6085 runlevels, <prgn>init</prgn> looks in the directory
6086 <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> for the scripts it should
6087 execute, where <tt><var>n</var></tt> is the runlevel that
6088 is being changed to, or <tt>S</tt> for the boot-up
6093 The names of the links all have the form
6094 <file>S<var>mm</var><var>script</var></file> or
6095 <file>K<var>mm</var><var>script</var></file> where
6096 <var>mm</var> is a two-digit number and <var>script</var>
6097 is the name of the script (this should be the same as the
6098 name of the actual script in <file>/etc/init.d</file>).
6102 When <prgn>init</prgn> changes runlevel first the targets
6103 of the links whose names start with a <tt>K</tt> are
6104 executed, each with the single argument <tt>stop</tt>,
6105 followed by the scripts prefixed with an <tt>S</tt>, each
6106 with the single argument <tt>start</tt>. (The links are
6107 those in the <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directory
6108 corresponding to the new runlevel.) The <tt>K</tt> links
6109 are responsible for killing services and the <tt>S</tt>
6110 link for starting services upon entering the runlevel.
6114 For example, if we are changing from runlevel 2 to
6115 runlevel 3, init will first execute all of the <tt>K</tt>
6116 prefixed scripts it finds in <file>/etc/rc3.d</file>, and then
6117 all of the <tt>S</tt> prefixed scripts in that directory.
6118 The links starting with <tt>K</tt> will cause the
6119 referred-to file to be executed with an argument of
6120 <tt>stop</tt>, and the <tt>S</tt> links with an argument
6125 The two-digit number <var>mm</var> is used to determine
6126 the order in which to run the scripts: low-numbered links
6127 have their scripts run first. For example, the
6128 <tt>K20</tt> scripts will be executed before the
6129 <tt>K30</tt> scripts. This is used when a certain service
6130 must be started before another. For example, the name
6131 server <prgn>bind</prgn> might need to be started before
6132 the news server <prgn>inn</prgn> so that <prgn>inn</prgn>
6133 can set up its access lists. In this case, the script
6134 that starts <prgn>bind</prgn> would have a lower number
6135 than the script that starts <prgn>inn</prgn> so that it
6137 <example compact="compact">
6144 The two runlevels 0 (halt) and 6 (reboot) are slightly
6145 different. In these runlevels, the links with an
6146 <tt>S</tt> prefix are still called after those with a
6147 <tt>K</tt> prefix, but they too are called with the single
6148 argument <tt>stop</tt>.
6152 <sect1 id="writing-init">
6153 <heading>Writing the scripts</heading>
6156 Packages that include daemons for system services should
6157 place scripts in <file>/etc/init.d</file> to start or stop
6158 services at boot time or during a change of runlevel.
6159 These scripts should be named
6160 <file>/etc/init.d/<var>package</var></file>, and they should
6161 accept one argument, saying what to do:
6164 <tag><tt>start</tt></tag>
6165 <item>start the service,</item>
6167 <tag><tt>stop</tt></tag>
6168 <item>stop the service,</item>
6170 <tag><tt>restart</tt></tag>
6171 <item>stop and restart the service if it's already running,
6172 otherwise start the service</item>
6174 <tag><tt>reload</tt></tag>
6175 <item><p>cause the configuration of the service to be
6176 reloaded without actually stopping and restarting
6179 <tag><tt>force-reload</tt></tag>
6180 <item>cause the configuration to be reloaded if the
6181 service supports this, otherwise restart the
6185 The <tt>start</tt>, <tt>stop</tt>, <tt>restart</tt>, and
6186 <tt>force-reload</tt> options should be supported by all
6187 scripts in <file>/etc/init.d</file>, the <tt>reload</tt>
6192 The <file>init.d</file> scripts must ensure that they will
6193 behave sensibly (i.e., returning success and not starting
6194 multiple copies of a service) if invoked with <tt>start</tt>
6195 when the service is already running, or with <tt>stop</tt>
6196 when it isn't, and that they don't kill unfortunately-named
6197 user processes. The best way to achieve this is usually to
6198 use <prgn>start-stop-daemon</prgn> with the <tt>--oknodo</tt>
6203 Be careful of using <tt>set -e</tt> in <file>init.d</file>
6204 scripts. Writing correct <file>init.d</file> scripts requires
6205 accepting various error exit statuses when daemons are already
6206 running or already stopped without aborting
6207 the <file>init.d</file> script, and common <file>init.d</file>
6208 function libraries are not safe to call with <tt>set -e</tt>
6210 <tt>/lib/lsb/init-functions</tt>, which assists in writing
6211 LSB-compliant init scripts, may fail if <tt>set -e</tt> is
6212 in effect and echoing status messages to the console fails,
6214 </footnote>. For <tt>init.d</tt> scripts, it's often easier
6215 to not use <tt>set -e</tt> and instead check the result of
6216 each command separately.
6220 If a service reloads its configuration automatically (as
6221 in the case of <prgn>cron</prgn>, for example), the
6222 <tt>reload</tt> option of the <file>init.d</file> script
6223 should behave as if the configuration has been reloaded
6228 The <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts must be treated as
6229 configuration files, either (if they are present in the
6230 package, that is, in the .deb file) by marking them as
6231 <tt>conffile</tt>s, or, (if they do not exist in the .deb)
6232 by managing them correctly in the maintainer scripts (see
6233 <ref id="config-files">). This is important since we want
6234 to give the local system administrator the chance to adapt
6235 the scripts to the local system, e.g., to disable a
6236 service without de-installing the package, or to specify
6237 some special command line options when starting a service,
6238 while making sure their changes aren't lost during the next
6243 These scripts should not fail obscurely when the
6244 configuration files remain but the package has been
6245 removed, as configuration files remain on the system after
6246 the package has been removed. Only when <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
6247 is executed with the <tt>--purge</tt> option will
6248 configuration files be removed. In particular, as the
6249 <file>/etc/init.d/<var>package</var></file> script itself is
6250 usually a <tt>conffile</tt>, it will remain on the system
6251 if the package is removed but not purged. Therefore, you
6252 should include a <tt>test</tt> statement at the top of the
6254 <example compact="compact">
6255 test -f <var>program-executed-later-in-script</var> || exit 0
6260 Often there are some variables in the <file>init.d</file>
6261 scripts whose values control the behavior of the scripts,
6262 and which a system administrator is likely to want to
6263 change. As the scripts themselves are frequently
6264 <tt>conffile</tt>s, modifying them requires that the
6265 administrator merge in their changes each time the package
6266 is upgraded and the <tt>conffile</tt> changes. To ease
6267 the burden on the system administrator, such configurable
6268 values should not be placed directly in the script.
6269 Instead, they should be placed in a file in
6270 <file>/etc/default</file>, which typically will have the same
6271 base name as the <file>init.d</file> script. This extra file
6272 should be sourced by the script when the script runs. It
6273 must contain only variable settings and comments in SUSv3
6274 <prgn>sh</prgn> format. It may either be a
6275 <tt>conffile</tt> or a configuration file maintained by
6276 the package maintainer scripts. See <ref id="config-files">
6281 To ensure that vital configurable values are always
6282 available, the <file>init.d</file> script should set default
6283 values for each of the shell variables it uses, either
6284 before sourcing the <file>/etc/default/</file> file or
6285 afterwards using something like the <tt>:
6286 ${VAR:=default}</tt> syntax. Also, the <file>init.d</file>
6287 script must behave sensibly and not fail if the
6288 <file>/etc/default</file> file is deleted.
6292 <file>/var/run</file> and <file>/var/lock</file> may be mounted
6293 as temporary filesystems<footnote>
6294 For example, using the <tt>RAMRUN</tt> and <tt>RAMLOCK</tt>
6295 options in <file>/etc/default/rcS</file>.
6296 </footnote>, so the <file>init.d</file> scripts must handle this
6297 correctly. This will typically amount to creating any required
6298 subdirectories dynamically when the <file>init.d</file> script
6299 is run, rather than including them in the package and relying on
6300 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to create them.
6305 <heading>Interfacing with the initscript system</heading>
6308 Maintainers should use the abstraction layer provided by
6309 the <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> and <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>
6310 programs to deal with initscripts in their packages'
6311 scripts such as <prgn>postinst</prgn>, <prgn>prerm</prgn>
6312 and <prgn>postrm</prgn>.
6316 Directly managing the /etc/rc?.d links and directly
6317 invoking the <file>/etc/init.d/</file> initscripts should
6318 be done only by packages providing the initscript
6319 subsystem (such as <prgn>sysv-rc</prgn> and
6320 <prgn>file-rc</prgn>).
6324 <heading>Managing the links</heading>
6327 The program <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> is provided for
6328 package maintainers to arrange for the proper creation and
6329 removal of <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> symbolic links,
6330 or their functional equivalent if another method is being
6331 used. This may be used by maintainers in their packages'
6332 <prgn>postinst</prgn> and <prgn>postrm</prgn> scripts.
6336 You must not include any <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file>
6337 symbolic links in the actual archive or manually create or
6338 remove the symbolic links in maintainer scripts; you must
6339 use the <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> program instead. (The
6340 former will fail if an alternative method of maintaining
6341 runlevel information is being used.) You must not include
6342 the <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> directories themselves
6343 in the archive either. (Only the <tt>sysvinit</tt>
6348 By default <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> will start services in
6349 each of the multi-user state runlevels (2, 3, 4, and 5)
6350 and stop them in the halt runlevel (0), the single-user
6351 runlevel (1) and the reboot runlevel (6). The system
6352 administrator will have the opportunity to customize
6353 runlevels by simply adding, moving, or removing the
6354 symbolic links in <file>/etc/rc<var>n</var>.d</file> if
6355 symbolic links are being used, or by modifying
6356 <file>/etc/runlevel.conf</file> if the <tt>file-rc</tt> method
6361 To get the default behavior for your package, put in your
6362 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script
6363 <example compact="compact">
6364 update-rc.d <var>package</var> defaults
6366 and in your <prgn>postrm</prgn>
6367 <example compact="compact">
6368 if [ "$1" = purge ]; then
6369 update-rc.d <var>package</var> remove
6371 </example>. Note that if your package changes runlevels
6372 or priority, you may have to remove and recreate the links,
6373 since otherwise the old links may persist. Refer to the
6374 documentation of <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn>.
6378 This will use a default sequence number of 20. If it does
6379 not matter when or in which order the <file>init.d</file>
6380 script is run, use this default. If it does, then you
6381 should talk to the maintainer of the <prgn>sysvinit</prgn>
6382 package or post to <tt>debian-devel</tt>, and they will
6383 help you choose a number.
6387 For more information about using <tt>update-rc.d</tt>,
6388 please consult its man page <manref name="update-rc.d"
6394 <heading>Running initscripts</heading>
6396 The program <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> is provided to make
6397 it easier for package maintainers to properly invoke an
6398 initscript, obeying runlevel and other locally-defined
6399 constraints that might limit a package's right to start,
6400 stop and otherwise manage services. This program may be
6401 used by maintainers in their packages' scripts.
6405 The package maintainer scripts must use
6406 <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> to invoke the
6407 <file>/etc/init.d/*</file> initscripts, instead of
6408 calling them directly.
6412 By default, <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn> will pass any
6413 action requests (start, stop, reload, restart...) to the
6414 <file>/etc/init.d</file> script, filtering out requests
6415 to start or restart a service out of its intended
6420 Most packages will simply need to change:
6421 <example compact="compact">/etc/init.d/<package>
6422 <action></example> in their <prgn>postinst</prgn>
6423 and <prgn>prerm</prgn> scripts to:
6424 <example compact="compact">
6425 if which invoke-rc.d >/dev/null 2>&1; then
6426 invoke-rc.d <var>package</var> <action>
6428 /etc/init.d/<var>package</var> <action>
6434 A package should register its initscript services using
6435 <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> before it tries to invoke them
6436 using <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>. Invocation of
6437 unregistered services may fail.
6441 For more information about using
6442 <prgn>invoke-rc.d</prgn>, please consult its man page
6443 <manref name="invoke-rc.d" section="8">.
6449 <heading>Boot-time initialization</heading>
6452 There used to be another directory, <file>/etc/rc.boot</file>,
6453 which contained scripts which were run once per machine
6454 boot. This has been deprecated in favour of links from
6455 <file>/etc/rcS.d</file> to files in <file>/etc/init.d</file> as
6456 described in <ref id="/etc/init.d">. Packages must not
6457 place files in <file>/etc/rc.boot</file>.
6462 <heading>Example</heading>
6465 An example on which you can base your
6466 <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts is found in
6467 <file>/etc/init.d/skeleton</file>.
6474 <heading>Console messages from <file>init.d</file> scripts</heading>
6477 This section describes the formats to be used for messages
6478 written to standard output by the <file>/etc/init.d</file>
6479 scripts. The intent is to improve the consistency of
6480 Debian's startup and shutdown look and feel. For this
6481 reason, please look very carefully at the details. We want
6482 the messages to have the same format in terms of wording,
6483 spaces, punctuation and case of letters.
6487 Here is a list of overall rules that should be used for
6488 messages generated by <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts.
6494 The message should fit in one line (fewer than 80
6495 characters), start with a capital letter and end with
6496 a period (<tt>.</tt>) and line feed (<tt>"\n"</tt>).
6500 If the script is performing some time consuming task in
6501 the background (not merely starting or stopping a
6502 program, for instance), an ellipsis (three dots:
6503 <tt>...</tt>) should be output to the screen, with no
6504 leading or tailing whitespace or line feeds.
6508 The messages should appear as if the computer is telling
6509 the user what it is doing (politely :-), but should not
6510 mention "it" directly. For example, instead of:
6511 <example compact="compact">
6512 I'm starting network daemons: nfsd mountd.
6514 the message should say
6515 <example compact="compact">
6516 Starting network daemons: nfsd mountd.
6523 <tt>init.d</tt> script should use the following standard
6524 message formats for the situations enumerated below.
6530 <p>When daemons are started</p>
6533 If the script starts one or more daemons, the output
6534 should look like this (a single line, no leading
6536 <example compact="compact">
6537 Starting <var>description</var>: <var>daemon-1</var> ... <var>daemon-n</var>.
6539 The <var>description</var> should describe the
6540 subsystem the daemon or set of daemons are part of,
6541 while <var>daemon-1</var> up to <var>daemon-n</var>
6542 denote each daemon's name (typically the file name of
6547 For example, the output of <file>/etc/init.d/lpd</file>
6549 <example compact="compact">
6550 Starting printer spooler: lpd.
6555 This can be achieved by saying
6556 <example compact="compact">
6557 echo -n "Starting printer spooler: lpd"
6558 start-stop-daemon --start --quiet --exec /usr/sbin/lpd
6561 in the script. If there are more than one daemon to
6562 start, the output should look like this:
6563 <example compact="compact">
6564 echo -n "Starting remote file system services:"
6565 echo -n " nfsd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet nfsd
6566 echo -n " mountd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet mountd
6567 echo -n " ugidd"; start-stop-daemon --start --quiet ugidd
6570 This makes it possible for the user to see what is
6571 happening and when the final daemon has been started.
6572 Care should be taken in the placement of white spaces:
6573 in the example above the system administrators can
6574 easily comment out a line if they don't want to start
6575 a specific daemon, while the displayed message still
6581 <p>When a system parameter is being set</p>
6584 If you have to set up different system parameters
6585 during the system boot, you should use this format:
6586 <example compact="compact">
6587 Setting <var>parameter</var> to "<var>value</var>".
6592 You can use a statement such as the following to get
6594 <example compact="compact">
6595 echo "Setting DNS domainname to \"$domainname\"."
6600 Note that the same symbol (<tt>"</tt>) <!-- " --> is used
6601 for the left and right quotation marks. A grave accent
6602 (<tt>`</tt>) is not a quote character; neither is an
6603 apostrophe (<tt>'</tt>).
6608 <p>When a daemon is stopped or restarted</p>
6611 When you stop or restart a daemon, you should issue a
6612 message identical to the startup message, except that
6613 <tt>Starting</tt> is replaced with <tt>Stopping</tt>
6614 or <tt>Restarting</tt> respectively.
6618 For example, stopping the printer daemon will look like
6620 <example compact="compact">
6621 Stopping printer spooler: lpd.
6627 <p>When something is executed</p>
6630 There are several examples where you have to run a
6631 program at system startup or shutdown to perform a
6632 specific task, for example, setting the system's clock
6633 using <prgn>netdate</prgn> or killing all processes
6634 when the system shuts down. Your message should look
6636 <example compact="compact">
6637 Doing something very useful...done.
6639 You should print the <tt>done.</tt> immediately after
6640 the job has been completed, so that the user is
6641 informed why they have to wait. You can get this
6643 <example compact="compact">
6644 echo -n "Doing something very useful..."
6653 <p>When the configuration is reloaded</p>
6656 When a daemon is forced to reload its configuration
6657 files you should use the following format:
6658 <example compact="compact">
6659 Reloading <var>description</var> configuration...done.
6661 where <var>description</var> is the same as in the
6662 daemon starting message.
6670 <heading>Cron jobs</heading>
6673 Packages must not modify the configuration file
6674 <file>/etc/crontab</file>, and they must not modify the files in
6675 <file>/var/spool/cron/crontabs</file>.</p>
6678 If a package wants to install a job that has to be executed
6679 via cron, it should place a file with the name of the
6680 package in one or more of the following directories:
6681 <example compact="compact">
6687 As these directory names imply, the files within them are
6688 executed on an hourly, daily, weekly, or monthly basis,
6689 respectively. The exact times are listed in
6690 <file>/etc/crontab</file>.</p>
6693 All files installed in any of these directories must be
6694 scripts (e.g., shell scripts or Perl scripts) so that they
6695 can easily be modified by the local system administrator.
6696 In addition, they must be treated as configuration files.
6700 If a certain job has to be executed at some other frequency or
6701 at a specific time, the package should install a file
6702 <file>/etc/cron.d/<var>package</var></file>. This file uses the
6703 same syntax as <file>/etc/crontab</file> and is processed by
6704 <prgn>cron</prgn> automatically. The file must also be
6705 treated as a configuration file. (Note that entries in the
6706 <file>/etc/cron.d</file> directory are not handled by
6707 <prgn>anacron</prgn>. Thus, you should only use this
6708 directory for jobs which may be skipped if the system is not
6711 Unlike <file>crontab</file> files described in the IEEE Std
6712 1003.1-2008 (POSIX.1) available from
6713 <url id="http://www.opengroup.org/onlinepubs/9699919799/"
6714 name="The Open Group">, the files in
6715 <file>/etc/cron.d</file> and the file
6716 <file>/etc/crontab</file> have seven fields; namely:
6718 <item>Minute [0,59]</item>
6719 <item>Hour [0,23]</item>
6720 <item>Day of the month [1,31]</item>
6721 <item>Month of the year [1,12]</item>
6722 <item>Day of the week ([0,6] with 0=Sunday)</item>
6723 <item>Username</item>
6724 <item>Command to be run</item>
6726 Ranges of numbers are allowed. Ranges are two numbers
6727 separated with a hyphen. The specified range is inclusive.
6728 Lists are allowed. A list is a set of numbers (or ranges)
6729 separated by commas. Step values can be used in conjunction
6734 The scripts or <tt>crontab</tt> entries in these directories should
6735 check if all necessary programs are installed before they
6736 try to execute them. Otherwise, problems will arise when a
6737 package was removed but not purged since configuration files
6738 are kept on the system in this situation.
6742 Any <tt>cron</tt> daemon must provide
6743 <file>/usr/bin/crontab</file> and support normal
6744 <tt>crontab</tt> entries as specified in POSIX. The daemon
6745 must also support names for days and months, ranges, and
6746 step values. It has to support <file>/etc/crontab</file>,
6747 and correctly execute the scripts in
6748 <file>/etc/cron.d</file>. The daemon must also correctly
6750 <file>/etc/cron.{hourly,daily,weekly,monthly}</file>.
6755 <heading>Menus</heading>
6758 The Debian <tt>menu</tt> package provides a standard
6759 interface between packages providing applications and
6760 <em>menu programs</em> (either X window managers or
6761 text-based menu programs such as <prgn>pdmenu</prgn>).
6765 All packages that provide applications that need not be
6766 passed any special command line arguments for normal
6767 operation should register a menu entry for those
6768 applications, so that users of the <tt>menu</tt> package
6769 will automatically get menu entries in their window
6770 managers, as well in shells like <tt>pdmenu</tt>.
6774 Menu entries should follow the current menu policy.
6778 The menu policy can be found in the <tt>menu-policy</tt>
6779 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
6780 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
6781 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/menu-policy/"
6782 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/menu-policy/"></tt>.
6786 Please also refer to the <em>Debian Menu System</em>
6787 documentation that comes with the <package>menu</package>
6788 package for information about how to register your
6794 <heading>Multimedia handlers</heading>
6797 MIME (Multipurpose Internet Mail Extensions, RFCs 2045-2049)
6798 is a mechanism for encoding files and data streams and
6799 providing meta-information about them, in particular their
6800 type (e.g. audio or video) and format (e.g. PNG, HTML,
6805 Registration of MIME type handlers allows programs like mail
6806 user agents and web browsers to invoke these handlers to
6807 view, edit or display MIME types they don't support directly.
6811 Packages which provide the ability to view/show/play,
6812 compose, edit or print MIME types should register themselves
6813 as such following the current MIME support policy.
6817 The MIME support policy can be found in the <tt>mime-policy</tt>
6818 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
6819 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
6820 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/mime-policy/"
6821 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/mime-policy/"></tt>.
6827 <heading>Keyboard configuration</heading>
6830 To achieve a consistent keyboard configuration so that all
6831 applications interpret a keyboard event the same way, all
6832 programs in the Debian distribution must be configured to
6833 comply with the following guidelines.
6837 The following keys must have the specified interpretations:
6840 <tag><tt><--</tt></tag>
6841 <item>delete the character to the left of the cursor</item>
6843 <tag><tt>Delete</tt></tag>
6844 <item>delete the character to the right of the cursor</item>
6846 <tag><tt>Control+H</tt></tag>
6847 <item>emacs: the help prefix</item>
6850 The interpretation of any keyboard events should be
6851 independent of the terminal that is used, be it a virtual
6852 console, an X terminal emulator, an rlogin/telnet session,
6857 The following list explains how the different programs
6858 should be set up to achieve this:
6864 <tt><--</tt> generates <tt>KB_BackSpace</tt> in X.
6868 <tt>Delete</tt> generates <tt>KB_Delete</tt> in X.
6872 X translations are set up to make
6873 <tt>KB_Backspace</tt> generate ASCII DEL, and to make
6874 <tt>KB_Delete</tt> generate <tt>ESC [ 3 ~</tt> (this
6875 is the vt220 escape code for the "delete character"
6876 key). This must be done by loading the X resources
6877 using <prgn>xrdb</prgn> on all local X displays, not
6878 using the application defaults, so that the
6879 translation resources used correspond to the
6880 <prgn>xmodmap</prgn> settings.
6884 The Linux console is configured to make
6885 <tt><--</tt> generate DEL, and <tt>Delete</tt>
6886 generate <tt>ESC [ 3 ~</tt>.
6890 X applications are configured so that <tt><</tt>
6891 deletes left, and <tt>Delete</tt> deletes right. Motif
6892 applications already work like this.
6896 Terminals should have <tt>stty erase ^?</tt> .
6900 The <tt>xterm</tt> terminfo entry should have <tt>ESC
6901 [ 3 ~</tt> for <tt>kdch1</tt>, just as for
6902 <tt>TERM=linux</tt> and <tt>TERM=vt220</tt>.
6906 Emacs is programmed to map <tt>KB_Backspace</tt> or
6907 the <tt>stty erase</tt> character to
6908 <tt>delete-backward-char</tt>, and <tt>KB_Delete</tt>
6909 or <tt>kdch1</tt> to <tt>delete-forward-char</tt>, and
6910 <tt>^H</tt> to <tt>help</tt> as always.
6914 Other applications use the <tt>stty erase</tt>
6915 character and <tt>kdch1</tt> for the two delete keys,
6916 with ASCII DEL being "delete previous character" and
6917 <tt>kdch1</tt> being "delete character under
6925 This will solve the problem except for the following
6932 Some terminals have a <tt><--</tt> key that cannot
6933 be made to produce anything except <tt>^H</tt>. On
6934 these terminals Emacs help will be unavailable on
6935 <tt>^H</tt> (assuming that the <tt>stty erase</tt>
6936 character takes precedence in Emacs, and has been set
6937 correctly). <tt>M-x help</tt> or <tt>F1</tt> (if
6938 available) can be used instead.
6942 Some operating systems use <tt>^H</tt> for <tt>stty
6943 erase</tt>. However, modern telnet versions and all
6944 rlogin versions propagate <tt>stty</tt> settings, and
6945 almost all UNIX versions honour <tt>stty erase</tt>.
6946 Where the <tt>stty</tt> settings are not propagated
6947 correctly, things can be made to work by using
6948 <tt>stty</tt> manually.
6952 Some systems (including previous Debian versions) use
6953 <prgn>xmodmap</prgn> to arrange for both
6954 <tt><--</tt> and <tt>Delete</tt> to generate
6955 <tt>KB_Delete</tt>. We can change the behavior of
6956 their X clients using the same X resources that we use
6957 to do it for our own clients, or configure our clients
6958 using their resources when things are the other way
6959 around. On displays configured like this
6960 <tt>Delete</tt> will not work, but <tt><--</tt>
6965 Some operating systems have different <tt>kdch1</tt>
6966 settings in their <tt>terminfo</tt> database for
6967 <tt>xterm</tt> and others. On these systems the
6968 <tt>Delete</tt> key will not work correctly when you
6969 log in from a system conforming to our policy, but
6970 <tt><--</tt> will.
6977 <heading>Environment variables</heading>
6980 A program must not depend on environment variables to get
6981 reasonable defaults. (That's because these environment
6982 variables would have to be set in a system-wide
6983 configuration file like <file>/etc/profile</file>, which is not
6984 supported by all shells.)
6988 If a program usually depends on environment variables for its
6989 configuration, the program should be changed to fall back to
6990 a reasonable default configuration if these environment
6991 variables are not present. If this cannot be done easily
6992 (e.g., if the source code of a non-free program is not
6993 available), the program must be replaced by a small
6994 "wrapper" shell script which sets the environment variables
6995 if they are not already defined, and calls the original program.
6999 Here is an example of a wrapper script for this purpose:
7001 <example compact="compact">
7003 BAR=${BAR:-/var/lib/fubar}
7005 exec /usr/lib/foo/foo "$@"
7010 Furthermore, as <file>/etc/profile</file> is a configuration
7011 file of the <prgn>base-files</prgn> package, other packages must
7012 not put any environment variables or other commands into that
7017 <sect id="doc-base">
7018 <heading>Registering Documents using doc-base</heading>
7021 The <package>doc-base</package> package implements a
7022 flexible mechanism for handling and presenting
7023 documentation. The recommended practice is for every Debian
7024 package that provides online documentation (other than just
7025 manual pages) to register these documents with
7026 <package>doc-base</package> by installing a
7027 <package>doc-base</package> control file via the
7028 <prgn/install-docs/ script at installation time and
7029 de-register the manuals again when the package is removed.
7032 Please refer to the documentation that comes with the
7033 <package>doc-base</package> package for information and
7042 <heading>Files</heading>
7045 <heading>Binaries</heading>
7048 Two different packages must not install programs with
7049 different functionality but with the same filenames. (The
7050 case of two programs having the same functionality but
7051 different implementations is handled via "alternatives" or
7052 the "Conflicts" mechanism. See <ref id="maintscripts"> and
7053 <ref id="conflicts"> respectively.) If this case happens,
7054 one of the programs must be renamed. The maintainers should
7055 report this to the <tt>debian-devel</tt> mailing list and
7056 try to find a consensus about which program will have to be
7057 renamed. If a consensus cannot be reached, <em>both</em>
7058 programs must be renamed.
7062 By default, when a package is being built, any binaries
7063 created should include debugging information, as well as
7064 being compiled with optimization. You should also turn on
7065 as many reasonable compilation warnings as possible; this
7066 makes life easier for porters, who can then look at build
7067 logs for possible problems. For the C programming language,
7068 this means the following compilation parameters should be
7070 <example compact="compact">
7072 CFLAGS = -O2 -g -Wall # sane warning options vary between programs
7074 INSTALL = install -s # (or use strip on the files in debian/tmp)
7079 Note that by default all installed binaries should be stripped,
7080 either by using the <tt>-s</tt> flag to
7081 <prgn>install</prgn>, or by calling <prgn>strip</prgn> on
7082 the binaries after they have been copied into
7083 <file>debian/tmp</file> but before the tree is made into a
7088 Although binaries in the build tree should be compiled with
7089 debugging information by default, it can often be difficult to
7090 debug programs if they are also subjected to compiler
7091 optimization. For this reason, it is recommended to support the
7092 standardized environment variable <tt>DEB_BUILD_OPTIONS</tt>
7093 (see <ref id="debianrules-options">). This variable can contain
7094 several flags to change how a package is compiled and built.
7098 It is up to the package maintainer to decide what
7099 compilation options are best for the package. Certain
7100 binaries (such as computationally-intensive programs) will
7101 function better with certain flags (<tt>-O3</tt>, for
7102 example); feel free to use them. Please use good judgment
7103 here. Don't use flags for the sake of it; only use them
7104 if there is good reason to do so. Feel free to override
7105 the upstream author's ideas about which compilation
7106 options are best: they are often inappropriate for our
7112 <sect id="libraries">
7113 <heading>Libraries</heading>
7116 If the package is <strong>architecture: any</strong>, then
7117 the shared library compilation and linking flags must have
7118 <tt>-fPIC</tt>, or the package shall not build on some of
7119 the supported architectures<footnote>
7121 If you are using GCC, <tt>-fPIC</tt> produces code with
7122 relocatable position independent code, which is required for
7123 most architectures to create a shared library, with i386 and
7124 perhaps some others where non position independent code is
7125 permitted in a shared library.
7128 Position independent code may have a performance penalty,
7129 especially on <tt>i386</tt>. However, in most cases the
7130 speed penalty must be measured against the memory wasted on
7131 the few architectures where non position independent code is
7134 </footnote>. Any exception to this rule must be discussed on
7135 the mailing list <em>debian-devel@lists.debian.org</em>, and
7136 a rough consensus obtained. The reasons for not compiling
7137 with <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag must be recorded in the file
7138 <tt>README.Debian</tt>, and care must be taken to either
7139 restrict the architecture or arrange for <tt>-fPIC</tt> to
7140 be used on architectures where it is required.<footnote>
7142 Some of the reasons why this might be required is if the
7143 library contains hand crafted assembly code that is not
7144 relocatable, the speed penalty is excessive for compute
7145 intensive libs, and similar reasons.
7150 As to the static libraries, the common case is not to have
7151 relocatable code, since there is no benefit, unless in specific
7152 cases; therefore the static version must not be compiled
7153 with the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag. Any exception to this rule
7154 should be discussed on the mailing list
7155 <em>debian-devel@lists.debian.org</em>, and the reasons for
7156 compiling with the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag must be recorded in
7157 the file <tt>README.Debian</tt>. <footnote>
7159 Some of the reasons for linking static libraries with
7160 the <tt>-fPIC</tt> flag are if, for example, one needs a
7161 Perl API for a library that is under rapid development,
7162 and has an unstable API, so shared libraries are
7163 pointless at this phase of the library's development. In
7164 that case, since Perl needs a library with relocatable
7165 code, it may make sense to create a static library with
7166 relocatable code. Another reason cited is if you are
7167 distilling various libraries into a common shared
7168 library, like <tt>mklibs</tt> does in the Debian
7174 In other words, if both a shared and a static library is
7175 being built, each source unit (<tt>*.c</tt>, for example,
7176 for C files) will need to be compiled twice, for the normal
7180 You must specify the gcc option <tt>-D_REENTRANT</tt>
7181 when building a library (either static or shared) to make
7182 the library compatible with LinuxThreads.
7186 Although not enforced by the build tools, shared libraries
7187 must be linked against all libraries that they use symbols from
7188 in the same way that binaries are. This ensures the correct
7189 functioning of the <qref id="sharedlibs-shlibdeps">shlibs</qref>
7190 system and guarantees that all libraries can be safely opened
7191 with <tt>dlopen()</tt>. Packagers may wish to use the gcc
7192 option <tt>-Wl,-z,defs</tt> when building a shared library.
7193 Since this option enforces symbol resolution at build time,
7194 a missing library reference will be caught early as a fatal
7199 All installed shared libraries should be stripped with
7200 <example compact="compact">
7201 strip --strip-unneeded <var>your-lib</var>
7203 (The option <tt>--strip-unneeded</tt> makes
7204 <prgn>strip</prgn> remove only the symbols which aren't
7205 needed for relocation processing.) Shared libraries can
7206 function perfectly well when stripped, since the symbols for
7207 dynamic linking are in a separate part of the ELF object
7209 You might also want to use the options
7210 <tt>--remove-section=.comment</tt> and
7211 <tt>--remove-section=.note</tt> on both shared libraries
7212 and executables, and <tt>--strip-debug</tt> on static
7218 Note that under some circumstances it may be useful to
7219 install a shared library unstripped, for example when
7220 building a separate package to support debugging.
7224 Shared object files (often <file>.so</file> files) that are not
7225 public libraries, that is, they are not meant to be linked
7226 to by third party executables (binaries of other packages),
7227 should be installed in subdirectories of the
7228 <file>/usr/lib</file> directory. Such files are exempt from the
7229 rules that govern ordinary shared libraries, except that
7230 they must not be installed executable and should be
7232 A common example are the so-called "plug-ins",
7233 internal shared objects that are dynamically loaded by
7234 programs using <manref name="dlopen" section="3">.
7239 An ever increasing number of packages are using
7240 <prgn>libtool</prgn> to do their linking. The latest GNU
7241 libtools (>= 1.3a) can take advantage of the metadata in the
7242 installed <prgn>libtool</prgn> archive files (<file>*.la</file>
7243 files). The main advantage of <prgn>libtool</prgn>'s
7244 <file>.la</file> files is that it allows <prgn>libtool</prgn> to
7245 store and subsequently access metadata with respect to the
7246 libraries it builds. <prgn>libtool</prgn> will search for
7247 those files, which contain a lot of useful information about
7248 a library (such as library dependency information for static
7249 linking). Also, they're <em>essential</em> for programs
7250 using <tt>libltdl</tt>.<footnote>
7251 Although <prgn>libtool</prgn> is fully capable of
7252 linking against shared libraries which don't have
7253 <tt>.la</tt> files, as it is a mere shell script it can
7254 add considerably to the build time of a
7255 <prgn>libtool</prgn>-using package if that shell script
7256 has to derive all this information from first principles
7257 for each library every time it is linked. With the
7258 advent of <prgn>libtool</prgn> version 1.4 (and to a
7259 lesser extent <prgn>libtool</prgn> version 1.3), the
7260 <file>.la</file> files also store information about
7261 inter-library dependencies which cannot necessarily be
7262 derived after the <file>.la</file> file is deleted.
7267 Packages that use <prgn>libtool</prgn> to create shared
7268 libraries should include the <file>.la</file> files in the
7269 <tt>-dev</tt> package, unless the package relies on
7270 <tt>libtool</tt>'s <tt>libltdl</tt> library, in which case
7271 the <tt>.la</tt> files must go in the run-time library
7276 You must make sure that you use only released versions of
7277 shared libraries to build your packages; otherwise other
7278 users will not be able to run your binaries
7279 properly. Producing source packages that depend on
7280 unreleased compilers is also usually a bad
7287 <heading>Shared libraries</heading>
7289 This section has moved to <ref id="sharedlibs">.
7295 <heading>Scripts</heading>
7298 All command scripts, including the package maintainer
7299 scripts inside the package and used by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>,
7300 should have a <tt>#!</tt> line naming the shell to be used
7305 In the case of Perl scripts this should be
7306 <tt>#!/usr/bin/perl</tt>.
7310 When scripts are installed into a directory in the system
7311 PATH, the script name should not include an extension such
7312 as <tt>.sh</tt> or <tt>.pl</tt> that denotes the scripting
7313 language currently used to implement it.
7316 Shell scripts (<prgn>sh</prgn> and <prgn>bash</prgn>) other than
7317 <file>init.d</file> scripts should almost certainly start
7318 with <tt>set -e</tt> so that errors are detected.
7319 <file>init.d</file> scripts are something of a special case, due
7320 to how frequently they need to call commands that are allowed to
7321 fail, and it may instead be easier to check the exit status of
7322 commands directly. See <ref id="writing-init"> for more
7323 information about writing <file>init.d</file> scripts.
7326 Every script should use <tt>set -e</tt> or check the exit status
7327 of <em>every</em> command.
7330 Scripts may assume that <file>/bin/sh</file> implements the
7331 SUSv3 Shell Command Language<footnote>
7332 Single UNIX Specification, version 3, which is also IEEE
7333 1003.1-2004 (POSIX), and is available on the World Wide Web
7334 from <url id="http://www.unix.org/version3/online.html"
7335 name="The Open Group"> after free
7336 registration.</footnote>
7337 plus the following additional features not mandated by
7339 These features are in widespread use in the Linux community
7340 and are implemented in all of bash, dash, and ksh, the most
7341 common shells users may wish to use as <file>/bin/sh</file>.
7344 <item><tt>echo -n</tt>, if implemented as a shell built-in,
7345 must not generate a newline.</item>
7346 <item><tt>test</tt>, if implemented as a shell built-in, must
7347 support <tt>-a</tt> and <tt>-o</tt> as binary logical
7349 <item><tt>local</tt> to create a scoped variable must be
7350 supported, including listing multiple variables in a single
7351 local command and assigning a value to a variable at the
7352 same time as localizing it. <tt>local</tt> may or
7353 may not preserve the variable value from an outer scope if
7354 no assignment is present. Uses such as:
7358 # ... use a, b, c, d ...
7361 must be supported and must set the value of <tt>c</tt> to
7365 If a shell script requires non-SUSv3 features from the shell
7366 interpreter other than those listed above, the appropriate shell
7367 must be specified in the first line of the script (e.g.,
7368 <tt>#!/bin/bash</tt>) and the package must depend on the package
7369 providing the shell (unless the shell package is marked
7370 "Essential", as in the case of <prgn>bash</prgn>).
7374 You may wish to restrict your script to SUSv3 features plus the
7375 above set when possible so that it may use <file>/bin/sh</file>
7376 as its interpreter. If your script works with <prgn>dash</prgn>
7377 (originally called <prgn>ash</prgn>), it probably complies with
7378 the above requirements, but if you are in doubt, use
7379 <file>/bin/bash</file>.
7383 Perl scripts should check for errors when making any
7384 system calls, including <tt>open</tt>, <tt>print</tt>,
7385 <tt>close</tt>, <tt>rename</tt> and <tt>system</tt>.
7389 <prgn>csh</prgn> and <prgn>tcsh</prgn> should be avoided as
7390 scripting languages. See <em>Csh Programming Considered
7391 Harmful</em>, one of the <tt>comp.unix.*</tt> FAQs, which
7392 can be found at <url id="http://www.faqs.org/faqs/unix-faq/shell/csh-whynot/">.
7393 If an upstream package comes with <prgn>csh</prgn> scripts
7394 then you must make sure that they start with
7395 <tt>#!/bin/csh</tt> and make your package depend on the
7396 <prgn>c-shell</prgn> virtual package.
7400 Any scripts which create files in world-writeable
7401 directories (e.g., in <file>/tmp</file>) must use a
7402 mechanism which will fail atomically if a file with the same
7403 name already exists.
7407 The Debian base system provides the <prgn>tempfile</prgn>
7408 and <prgn>mktemp</prgn> utilities for use by scripts for
7415 <heading>Symbolic links</heading>
7418 In general, symbolic links within a top-level directory
7419 should be relative, and symbolic links pointing from one
7420 top-level directory into another should be absolute. (A
7421 top-level directory is a sub-directory of the root
7422 directory <file>/</file>.)
7426 In addition, symbolic links should be specified as short as
7427 possible, i.e., link targets like <file>foo/../bar</file> are
7432 Note that when creating a relative link using
7433 <prgn>ln</prgn> it is not necessary for the target of the
7434 link to exist relative to the working directory you're
7435 running <prgn>ln</prgn> from, nor is it necessary to change
7436 directory to the directory where the link is to be made.
7437 Simply include the string that should appear as the target
7438 of the link (this will be a pathname relative to the
7439 directory in which the link resides) as the first argument
7444 For example, in your <prgn>Makefile</prgn> or
7445 <file>debian/rules</file>, you can do things like:
7446 <example compact="compact">
7447 ln -fs gcc $(prefix)/bin/cc
7448 ln -fs gcc debian/tmp/usr/bin/cc
7449 ln -fs ../sbin/sendmail $(prefix)/bin/runq
7450 ln -fs ../sbin/sendmail debian/tmp/usr/bin/runq
7455 A symbolic link pointing to a compressed file should always
7456 have the same file extension as the referenced file. (For
7457 example, if a file <file>foo.gz</file> is referenced by a
7458 symbolic link, the filename of the link has to end with
7459 "<file>.gz</file>" too, as in <file>bar.gz</file>.)
7464 <heading>Device files</heading>
7467 Packages must not include device files or named pipes in the
7472 If a package needs any special device files that are not
7473 included in the base system, it must call
7474 <prgn>MAKEDEV</prgn> in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script,
7475 after notifying the user<footnote>
7476 This notification could be done via a (low-priority)
7477 debconf message, or an echo (printf) statement.
7482 Packages must not remove any device files in the
7483 <prgn>postrm</prgn> or any other script. This is left to the
7484 system administrator.
7488 Debian uses the serial devices
7489 <file>/dev/ttyS*</file>. Programs using the old
7490 <file>/dev/cu*</file> devices should be changed to use
7491 <file>/dev/ttyS*</file>.
7495 Named pipes needed by the package must be created in
7496 the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script<footnote>
7497 It's better to use <prgn>mkfifo</prgn> rather
7498 than <prgn>mknod</prgn> to create named pipes so that
7499 automated checks for packages incorrectly creating device
7500 files with <prgn>mknod</prgn> won't have false positives.
7501 </footnote> and removed in
7502 the <prgn>prerm</prgn> or <prgn>postrm</prgn> script as
7507 <sect id="config-files">
7508 <heading>Configuration files</heading>
7511 <heading>Definitions</heading>
7515 <tag>configuration file</tag>
7517 A file that affects the operation of a program, or
7518 provides site- or host-specific information, or
7519 otherwise customizes the behavior of a program.
7520 Typically, configuration files are intended to be
7521 modified by the system administrator (if needed or
7522 desired) to conform to local policy or to provide
7523 more useful site-specific behavior.
7526 <tag><tt>conffile</tt></tag>
7528 A file listed in a package's <tt>conffiles</tt>
7529 file, and is treated specially by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
7530 (see <ref id="configdetails">).
7536 The distinction between these two is important; they are
7537 not interchangeable concepts. Almost all
7538 <tt>conffile</tt>s are configuration files, but many
7539 configuration files are not <tt>conffiles</tt>.
7543 As noted elsewhere, <file>/etc/init.d</file> scripts,
7544 <file>/etc/default</file> files, scripts installed in
7545 <file>/etc/cron.{hourly,daily,weekly,monthly}</file>, and cron
7546 configuration installed in <file>/etc/cron.d</file> must be
7547 treated as configuration files. In general, any script that
7548 embeds configuration information is de-facto a configuration
7549 file and should be treated as such.
7554 <heading>Location</heading>
7557 Any configuration files created or used by your package
7558 must reside in <file>/etc</file>. If there are several,
7559 consider creating a subdirectory of <file>/etc</file>
7560 named after your package.
7564 If your package creates or uses configuration files
7565 outside of <file>/etc</file>, and it is not feasible to modify
7566 the package to use <file>/etc</file> directly, put the files
7567 in <file>/etc</file> and create symbolic links to those files
7568 from the location that the package requires.
7573 <heading>Behavior</heading>
7576 Configuration file handling must conform to the following
7578 <list compact="compact">
7580 local changes must be preserved during a package
7584 configuration files must be preserved when the
7585 package is removed, and only deleted when the
7589 Obsolete configuration files without local changes may be
7590 removed by the package during upgrade.
7594 The easy way to achieve this behavior is to make the
7595 configuration file a <tt>conffile</tt>. This is
7596 appropriate only if it is possible to distribute a default
7597 version that will work for most installations, although
7598 some system administrators may choose to modify it. This
7599 implies that the default version will be part of the
7600 package distribution, and must not be modified by the
7601 maintainer scripts during installation (or at any other
7606 In order to ensure that local changes are preserved
7607 correctly, no package may contain or make hard links to
7608 conffiles.<footnote>
7609 Rationale: There are two problems with hard links.
7610 The first is that some editors break the link while
7611 editing one of the files, so that the two files may
7612 unwittingly become unlinked and different. The second
7613 is that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> might break the hard link
7614 while upgrading <tt>conffile</tt>s.
7619 The other way to do it is via the maintainer scripts. In
7620 this case, the configuration file must not be listed as a
7621 <tt>conffile</tt> and must not be part of the package
7622 distribution. If the existence of a file is required for
7623 the package to be sensibly configured it is the
7624 responsibility of the package maintainer to provide
7625 maintainer scripts which correctly create, update and
7626 maintain the file and remove it on purge. (See <ref
7627 id="maintainerscripts"> for more information.) These
7628 scripts must be idempotent (i.e., must work correctly if
7629 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> needs to re-run them due to errors
7630 during installation or removal), must cope with all the
7631 variety of ways <prgn>dpkg</prgn> can call maintainer
7632 scripts, must not overwrite or otherwise mangle the user's
7633 configuration without asking, must not ask unnecessary
7634 questions (particularly during upgrades), and must
7635 otherwise be good citizens.
7639 The scripts are not required to configure every possible
7640 option for the package, but only those necessary to get
7641 the package running on a given system. Ideally the
7642 sysadmin should not have to do any configuration other
7643 than that done (semi-)automatically by the
7644 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script.
7648 A common practice is to create a script called
7649 <file><var>package</var>-configure</file> and have the
7650 package's <prgn>postinst</prgn> call it if and only if the
7651 configuration file does not already exist. In certain
7652 cases it is useful for there to be an example or template
7653 file which the maintainer scripts use. Such files should
7654 be in <file>/usr/share/<var>package</var></file> or
7655 <file>/usr/lib/<var>package</var></file> (depending on whether
7656 they are architecture-independent or not). There should
7657 be symbolic links to them from
7658 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file> if
7659 they are examples, and should be perfectly ordinary
7660 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>-handled files (<em>not</em>
7661 configuration files).
7665 These two styles of configuration file handling must
7666 not be mixed, for that way lies madness:
7667 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will ask about overwriting the file
7668 every time the package is upgraded.
7673 <heading>Sharing configuration files</heading>
7676 Packages which specify the same file as a
7677 <tt>conffile</tt> must be tagged as <em>conflicting</em>
7678 with each other. (This is an instance of the general rule
7679 about not sharing files. Note that neither alternatives
7680 nor diversions are likely to be appropriate in this case;
7681 in particular, <prgn>dpkg</prgn> does not handle diverted
7682 <tt>conffile</tt>s well.)
7686 The maintainer scripts must not alter a <tt>conffile</tt>
7687 of <em>any</em> package, including the one the scripts
7692 If two or more packages use the same configuration file
7693 and it is reasonable for both to be installed at the same
7694 time, one of these packages must be defined as
7695 <em>owner</em> of the configuration file, i.e., it will be
7696 the package which handles that file as a configuration
7697 file. Other packages that use the configuration file must
7698 depend on the owning package if they require the
7699 configuration file to operate. If the other package will
7700 use the configuration file if present, but is capable of
7701 operating without it, no dependency need be declared.
7705 If it is desirable for two or more related packages to
7706 share a configuration file <em>and</em> for all of the
7707 related packages to be able to modify that configuration
7708 file, then the following should be done:
7709 <enumlist compact="compact">
7711 One of the related packages (the "owning" package)
7712 will manage the configuration file with maintainer
7713 scripts as described in the previous section.
7716 The owning package should also provide a program
7717 that the other packages may use to modify the
7721 The related packages must use the provided program
7722 to make any desired modifications to the
7723 configuration file. They should either depend on
7724 the core package to guarantee that the configuration
7725 modifier program is available or accept gracefully
7726 that they cannot modify the configuration file if it
7727 is not. (This is in addition to the fact that the
7728 configuration file may not even be present in the
7735 Sometimes it's appropriate to create a new package which
7736 provides the basic infrastructure for the other packages
7737 and which manages the shared configuration files. (The
7738 <tt>sgml-base</tt> package is a good example.)
7743 <heading>User configuration files ("dotfiles")</heading>
7746 The files in <file>/etc/skel</file> will automatically be
7747 copied into new user accounts by <prgn>adduser</prgn>.
7748 No other program should reference the files in
7749 <file>/etc/skel</file>.
7753 Therefore, if a program needs a dotfile to exist in
7754 advance in <file>$HOME</file> to work sensibly, that dotfile
7755 should be installed in <file>/etc/skel</file> and treated as a
7760 However, programs that require dotfiles in order to
7761 operate sensibly are a bad thing, unless they do create
7762 the dotfiles themselves automatically.
7766 Furthermore, programs should be configured by the Debian
7767 default installation to behave as closely to the upstream
7768 default behavior as possible.
7772 Therefore, if a program in a Debian package needs to be
7773 configured in some way in order to operate sensibly, that
7774 should be done using a site-wide configuration file placed
7775 in <file>/etc</file>. Only if the program doesn't support a
7776 site-wide default configuration and the package maintainer
7777 doesn't have time to add it may a default per-user file be
7778 placed in <file>/etc/skel</file>.
7782 <file>/etc/skel</file> should be as empty as we can make it.
7783 This is particularly true because there is no easy (or
7784 necessarily desirable) mechanism for ensuring that the
7785 appropriate dotfiles are copied into the accounts of
7786 existing users when a package is installed.
7792 <heading>Log files</heading>
7794 Log files should usually be named
7795 <file>/var/log/<var>package</var>.log</file>. If you have many
7796 log files, or need a separate directory for permission
7797 reasons (<file>/var/log</file> is writable only by
7798 <file>root</file>), you should usually create a directory named
7799 <file>/var/log/<var>package</var></file> and place your log
7804 Log files must be rotated occasionally so that they don't
7805 grow indefinitely; the best way to do this is to drop a log
7806 rotation configuration file into the directory
7807 <file>/etc/logrotate.d</file> and use the facilities provided by
7808 logrotate.<footnote>
7810 The traditional approach to log files has been to set up
7811 <em>ad hoc</em> log rotation schemes using simple shell
7812 scripts and cron. While this approach is highly
7813 customizable, it requires quite a lot of sysadmin work.
7814 Even though the original Debian system helped a little
7815 by automatically installing a system which can be used
7816 as a template, this was deemed not enough.
7820 The use of <prgn>logrotate</prgn>, a program developed
7821 by Red Hat, is better, as it centralizes log management.
7822 It has both a configuration file
7823 (<file>/etc/logrotate.conf</file>) and a directory where
7824 packages can drop their individual log rotation
7825 configurations (<file>/etc/logrotate.d</file>).
7828 Here is a good example for a logrotate config
7829 file (for more information see <manref name="logrotate"
7831 <example compact="compact">
7832 /var/log/foo/*.log {
7837 /etc/init.d/foo force-reload
7841 This rotates all files under <file>/var/log/foo</file>, saves 12
7842 compressed generations, and forces the daemon to reload its
7843 configuration information after the log rotation.
7847 Log files should be removed when the package is
7848 purged (but not when it is only removed). This should be
7849 done by the <prgn>postrm</prgn> script when it is called
7850 with the argument <tt>purge</tt> (see <ref
7851 id="removedetails">).
7856 <heading>Permissions and owners</heading>
7859 The rules in this section are guidelines for general use.
7860 If necessary you may deviate from the details below.
7861 However, if you do so you must make sure that what is done
7862 is secure and you should try to be as consistent as possible
7863 with the rest of the system. You should probably also
7864 discuss it on <prgn>debian-devel</prgn> first.
7868 Files should be owned by <tt>root:root</tt>, and made
7869 writable only by the owner and universally readable (and
7870 executable, if appropriate), that is mode 644 or 755.
7874 Directories should be mode 755 or (for group-writability)
7875 mode 2775. The ownership of the directory should be
7876 consistent with its mode: if a directory is mode 2775, it
7877 should be owned by the group that needs write access to
7880 When a package is upgraded, and the owner or permissions
7881 of a file included in the package has changed, dpkg
7882 arranges for the ownership and permissions to be
7883 correctly set upon installation. However, this does not
7884 extend to directories; the permissions and ownership of
7885 directories already on the system does not change on
7886 install or upgrade of packages. This makes sense, since
7887 otherwise common directories like <tt>/usr</tt> would
7888 always be in flux. To correctly change permissions of a
7889 directory the package owns, explicit action is required,
7890 usually in the <tt>postinst</tt> script. Care must be
7891 taken to handle downgrades as well, in that case.
7898 Setuid and setgid executables should be mode 4755 or 2755
7899 respectively, and owned by the appropriate user or group.
7900 They should not be made unreadable (modes like 4711 or
7901 2711 or even 4111); doing so achieves no extra security,
7902 because anyone can find the binary in the freely available
7903 Debian package; it is merely inconvenient. For the same
7904 reason you should not restrict read or execute permissions
7905 on non-set-id executables.
7909 Some setuid programs need to be restricted to particular
7910 sets of users, using file permissions. In this case they
7911 should be owned by the uid to which they are set-id, and by
7912 the group which should be allowed to execute them. They
7913 should have mode 4754; again there is no point in making
7914 them unreadable to those users who must not be allowed to
7919 It is possible to arrange that the system administrator can
7920 reconfigure the package to correspond to their local
7921 security policy by changing the permissions on a binary:
7922 they can do this by using <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>, as
7923 described below.<footnote>
7924 Ordinary files installed by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> (as
7925 opposed to <tt>conffile</tt>s and other similar objects)
7926 normally have their permissions reset to the distributed
7927 permissions when the package is reinstalled. However,
7928 the use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> overrides this
7931 Another method you should consider is to create a group for
7932 people allowed to use the program(s) and make any setuid
7933 executables executable only by that group.
7937 If you need to create a new user or group for your package
7938 there are two possibilities. Firstly, you may need to
7939 make some files in the binary package be owned by this
7940 user or group, or you may need to compile the user or
7941 group id (rather than just the name) into the binary
7942 (though this latter should be avoided if possible, as in
7943 this case you need a statically allocated id).</p>
7946 If you need a statically allocated id, you must ask for a
7947 user or group id from the <tt>base-passwd</tt> maintainer,
7948 and must not release the package until you have been
7949 allocated one. Once you have been allocated one you must
7950 either make the package depend on a version of the
7951 <tt>base-passwd</tt> package with the id present in
7952 <file>/etc/passwd</file> or <file>/etc/group</file>, or arrange for
7953 your package to create the user or group itself with the
7954 correct id (using <tt>adduser</tt>) in its
7955 <prgn>preinst</prgn> or <prgn>postinst</prgn>. (Doing it in
7956 the <prgn>postinst</prgn> is to be preferred if it is
7957 possible, otherwise a pre-dependency will be needed on the
7958 <tt>adduser</tt> package.)
7962 On the other hand, the program might be able to determine
7963 the uid or gid from the user or group name at runtime, so
7964 that a dynamically allocated id can be used. In this case
7965 you should choose an appropriate user or group name,
7966 discussing this on <prgn>debian-devel</prgn> and checking
7967 with the <package/base-passwd/ maintainer that it is unique and that
7968 they do not wish you to use a statically allocated id
7969 instead. When this has been checked you must arrange for
7970 your package to create the user or group if necessary using
7971 <prgn>adduser</prgn> in the <prgn>preinst</prgn> or
7972 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script (again, the latter is to be
7973 preferred if it is possible).
7977 Note that changing the numeric value of an id associated
7978 with a name is very difficult, and involves searching the
7979 file system for all appropriate files. You need to think
7980 carefully whether a static or dynamic id is required, since
7981 changing your mind later will cause problems.
7984 <sect1><heading>The use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn></heading>
7986 This section is not intended as policy, but as a
7987 description of the use of <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>.
7991 If a system administrator wishes to have a file (or
7992 directory or other such thing) installed with owner and
7993 permissions different from those in the distributed Debian
7994 package, they can use the <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn>
7995 program to instruct <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to use the different
7996 settings every time the file is installed. Thus the
7997 package maintainer should distribute the files with their
7998 normal permissions, and leave it for the system
7999 administrator to make any desired changes. For example, a
8000 daemon which is normally required to be setuid root, but
8001 in certain situations could be used without being setuid,
8002 should be installed setuid in the <tt>.deb</tt>. Then the
8003 local system administrator can change this if they wish.
8004 If there are two standard ways of doing it, the package
8005 maintainer can use <tt>debconf</tt> to find out the
8006 preference, and call <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> in the
8007 maintainer script if necessary to accommodate the system
8008 administrator's choice. Care must be taken during
8009 upgrades to not override an existing setting.
8013 Given the above, <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> is
8014 essentially a tool for system administrators and would not
8015 normally be needed in the maintainer scripts. There is
8016 one type of situation, though, where calls to
8017 <prgn>dpkg-statoverride</prgn> would be needed in the
8018 maintainer scripts, and that involves packages which use
8019 dynamically allocated user or group ids. In such a
8020 situation, something like the following idiom can be very
8021 helpful in the package's <prgn>postinst</prgn>, where
8022 <tt>sysuser</tt> is a dynamically allocated id:
8024 for i in /usr/bin/foo /usr/sbin/bar
8026 # only do something when no setting exists
8027 if ! dpkg-statoverride --list $i >/dev/null 2>&1
8029 #include: debconf processing, question about foo and bar
8030 if [ "$RET" = "true" ] ; then
8031 dpkg-statoverride --update --add sysuser root 4755 $i
8036 The corresponding code to remove the override when the package
8039 for i in /usr/bin/foo /usr/sbin/bar
8041 if dpkg-statoverride --list $i >/dev/null 2>&1
8043 dpkg-statoverride --remove $i
8053 <chapt id="customized-programs">
8054 <heading>Customized programs</heading>
8056 <sect id="arch-spec">
8057 <heading>Architecture specification strings</heading>
8060 If a program needs to specify an <em>architecture specification
8061 string</em> in some place, it should select one of the strings
8062 provided by <tt>dpkg-architecture -L</tt>. The strings are in
8063 the format <tt><var>os</var>-<var>arch</var></tt>, though the OS
8064 part is sometimes elided, as when the OS is Linux.
8068 Note that we don't want to use
8069 <tt><var>arch</var>-debian-linux</tt> to apply to the rule
8070 <tt><var>architecture</var>-<var>vendor</var>-<var>os</var></tt>
8071 since this would make our programs incompatible with other
8072 Linux distributions. We also don't use something like
8073 <tt><var>arch</var>-unknown-linux</tt>, since the
8074 <tt>unknown</tt> does not look very good.
8077 <sect1 id="arch-wildcard-spec">
8078 <heading>Architecture wildcards</heading>
8081 A package may specify an architecture wildcard. Architecture
8082 wildcards are in the format <tt>any</tt> (which matches every
8083 architecture), <tt><var>os</var></tt>-any, or
8084 any-<tt><var>cpu</var></tt>. <footnote>
8085 Internally, the package system normalizes the GNU triplets
8086 and the Debian arches into Debian arch triplets (which are
8087 kind of inverted GNU triplets), with the first component of
8088 the triplet representing the libc and ABI in use, and then
8089 does matching against those triplets. However, such
8090 triplets are an internal implementation detail that should
8091 not be used by packages directly. The libc and ABI portion
8092 is handled internally by the package system based on
8093 the <var>os</var> and <var>cpu</var>.
8100 <heading>Daemons</heading>
8103 The configuration files <file>/etc/services</file>,
8104 <file>/etc/protocols</file>, and <file>/etc/rpc</file> are managed
8105 by the <prgn>netbase</prgn> package and must not be modified
8110 If a package requires a new entry in one of these files, the
8111 maintainer should get in contact with the
8112 <prgn>netbase</prgn> maintainer, who will add the entries
8113 and release a new version of the <prgn>netbase</prgn>
8118 The configuration file <file>/etc/inetd.conf</file> must not be
8119 modified by the package's scripts except via the
8120 <prgn>update-inetd</prgn> script or the
8121 <file>DebianNet.pm</file> Perl module. See their documentation
8122 for details on how to add entries.
8126 If a package wants to install an example entry into
8127 <file>/etc/inetd.conf</file>, the entry must be preceded with
8128 exactly one hash character (<tt>#</tt>). Such lines are
8129 treated as "commented out by user" by the
8130 <prgn>update-inetd</prgn> script and are not changed or
8131 activated during package updates.
8136 <heading>Using pseudo-ttys and modifying wtmp, utmp and
8140 Some programs need to create pseudo-ttys. This should be done
8141 using Unix98 ptys if the C library supports it. The resulting
8142 program must not be installed setuid root, unless that
8143 is required for other functionality.
8147 The files <file>/var/run/utmp</file>, <file>/var/log/wtmp</file> and
8148 <file>/var/log/lastlog</file> must be installed writable by
8149 group <tt>utmp</tt>. Programs which need to modify those
8150 files must be installed setgid <tt>utmp</tt>.
8155 <heading>Editors and pagers</heading>
8158 Some programs have the ability to launch an editor or pager
8159 program to edit or display a text document. Since there are
8160 lots of different editors and pagers available in the Debian
8161 distribution, the system administrator and each user should
8162 have the possibility to choose their preferred editor and
8167 In addition, every program should choose a good default
8168 editor/pager if none is selected by the user or system
8173 Thus, every program that launches an editor or pager must
8174 use the EDITOR or PAGER environment variable to determine
8175 the editor or pager the user wishes to use. If these
8176 variables are not set, the programs <file>/usr/bin/editor</file>
8177 and <file>/usr/bin/pager</file> should be used, respectively.
8181 These two files are managed through the <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
8182 "alternatives" mechanism. Thus every package providing an
8183 editor or pager must call the
8184 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> script to register these
8189 If it is very hard to adapt a program to make use of the
8190 EDITOR or PAGER variables, that program may be configured to
8191 use <file>/usr/bin/sensible-editor</file> and
8192 <file>/usr/bin/sensible-pager</file> as the editor or pager
8193 program respectively. These are two scripts provided in the
8194 <package>sensible-utils</package> package that check the EDITOR
8195 and PAGER variables and launch the appropriate program, and fall
8196 back to <file>/usr/bin/editor</file>
8197 and <file>/usr/bin/pager</file> if the variable is not set.
8201 A program may also use the VISUAL environment variable to
8202 determine the user's choice of editor. If it exists, it
8203 should take precedence over EDITOR. This is in fact what
8204 <file>/usr/bin/sensible-editor</file> does.
8208 It is not required for a package to depend on
8209 <tt>editor</tt> and <tt>pager</tt>, nor is it required for a
8210 package to provide such virtual packages.<footnote>
8211 The Debian base system already provides an editor and a
8217 <sect id="web-appl">
8218 <heading>Web servers and applications</heading>
8221 This section describes the locations and URLs that should
8222 be used by all web servers and web applications in the
8229 Cgi-bin executable files are installed in the
8231 <example compact="compact">
8232 /usr/lib/cgi-bin/<var>cgi-bin-name</var>
8234 and should be referred to as
8235 <example compact="compact">
8236 http://localhost/cgi-bin/<var>cgi-bin-name</var>
8242 <p>Access to HTML documents</p>
8245 HTML documents for a package are stored in
8246 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>
8247 and can be referred to as
8248 <example compact="compact">
8249 http://localhost/doc/<var>package</var>/<var>filename</var>
8254 The web server should restrict access to the document
8255 tree so that only clients on the same host can read
8256 the documents. If the web server does not support such
8257 access controls, then it should not provide access at
8258 all, or ask about providing access during installation.
8263 <p>Access to images</p>
8265 It is recommended that images for a package be stored
8266 in <tt>/usr/share/images/<var>package</var></tt> and
8267 may be referred to through an alias <tt>/images/</tt>
8270 http://localhost/images/<package>/<filename>
8277 <p>Web Document Root</p>
8280 Web Applications should try to avoid storing files in
8281 the Web Document Root. Instead they should use the
8282 /usr/share/doc/<var>package</var> directory for
8283 documents and register the Web Application via the
8284 <package>doc-base</package> package. If access to the
8285 web document root is unavoidable then use
8286 <example compact="compact">
8289 as the Document Root. This might be just a symbolic
8290 link to the location where the system administrator
8291 has put the real document root.
8294 <item><p>Providing httpd and/or httpd-cgi</p>
8296 All web servers should provide the virtual package
8297 <tt>httpd</tt>. If a web server has CGI support it should
8298 provide <tt>httpd-cgi</tt> additionally.
8301 All web applications which do not contain CGI scripts should
8302 depend on <tt>httpd</tt>, all those web applications which
8303 <tt>do</tt> contain CGI scripts, should depend on
8311 <sect id="mail-transport-agents">
8312 <heading>Mail transport, delivery and user agents</heading>
8315 Debian packages which process electronic mail, whether mail
8316 user agents (MUAs) or mail transport agents (MTAs), must
8317 ensure that they are compatible with the configuration
8318 decisions below. Failure to do this may result in lost
8319 mail, broken <tt>From:</tt> lines, and other serious brain
8324 The mail spool is <file>/var/mail</file> and the interface to
8325 send a mail message is <file>/usr/sbin/sendmail</file> (as per
8326 the FHS). On older systems, the mail spool may be
8327 physically located in <file>/var/spool/mail</file>, but all
8328 access to the mail spool should be via the
8329 <file>/var/mail</file> symlink. The mail spool is part of the
8330 base system and not part of the MTA package.
8334 All Debian MUAs, MTAs, MDAs and other mailbox accessing
8335 programs (such as IMAP daemons) must lock the mailbox in an
8336 NFS-safe way. This means that <tt>fcntl()</tt> locking must
8337 be combined with dot locking. To avoid deadlocks, a program
8338 should use <tt>fcntl()</tt> first and dot locking after
8339 this, or alternatively implement the two locking methods in
8340 a non blocking way<footnote>
8341 If it is not possible to establish both locks, the
8342 system shouldn't wait for the second lock to be
8343 established, but remove the first lock, wait a (random)
8344 time, and start over locking again.
8345 </footnote>. Using the functions <tt>maillock</tt> and
8346 <tt>mailunlock</tt> provided by the
8347 <tt>liblockfile*</tt><footnote>
8348 You will need to depend on <tt>liblockfile1 (>>1.01)</tt>
8349 to use these functions.
8350 </footnote> packages is the recommended way to realize this.
8354 Mailboxes are generally either mode 600 and owned by
8355 <var>user</var> or mode 660 and owned by
8356 <tt><var>user</var>:mail</tt><footnote>
8357 There are two traditional permission schemes for mail spools:
8358 mode 600 with all mail delivery done by processes running as
8359 the destination user, or mode 660 and owned by group mail with
8360 mail delivery done by a process running as a system user in
8361 group mail. Historically, Debian required mode 660 mail
8362 spools to enable the latter model, but that model has become
8363 increasingly uncommon and the principle of least privilege
8364 indicates that mail systems that use the first model should
8365 use permissions of 600. If delivery to programs is permitted,
8366 it's easier to keep the mail system secure if the delivery
8367 agent runs as the destination user. Debian Policy therefore
8368 permits either scheme.
8369 </footnote>. The local system administrator may choose a
8370 different permission scheme; packages should not make
8371 assumptions about the permission and ownership of mailboxes
8372 unless required (such as when creating a new mailbox). A MUA
8373 may remove a mailbox (unless it has nonstandard permissions) in
8374 which case the MTA or another MUA must recreate it if needed.
8378 The mail spool is 2775 <tt>root:mail</tt>, and MUAs should
8379 be setgid mail to do the locking mentioned above (and
8380 must obviously avoid accessing other users' mailboxes
8381 using this privilege).</p>
8384 <file>/etc/aliases</file> is the source file for the system mail
8385 aliases (e.g., postmaster, usenet, etc.), it is the one
8386 which the sysadmin and <prgn>postinst</prgn> scripts may
8387 edit. After <file>/etc/aliases</file> is edited the program or
8388 human editing it must call <prgn>newaliases</prgn>. All MTA
8389 packages must come with a <prgn>newaliases</prgn> program,
8390 even if it does nothing, but older MTA packages did not do
8391 this so programs should not fail if <prgn>newaliases</prgn>
8392 cannot be found. Note that because of this, all MTA
8393 packages must have <tt>Provides</tt>, <tt>Conflicts</tt> and
8394 <tt>Replaces: mail-transport-agent</tt> control file
8399 The convention of writing <tt>forward to
8400 <var>address</var></tt> in the mailbox itself is not
8401 supported. Use a <tt>.forward</tt> file instead.</p>
8404 The <prgn>rmail</prgn> program used by UUCP
8405 for incoming mail should be <file>/usr/sbin/rmail</file>.
8406 Likewise, <prgn>rsmtp</prgn>, for receiving
8407 batch-SMTP-over-UUCP, should be <file>/usr/sbin/rsmtp</file> if it
8411 If your package needs to know what hostname to use on (for
8412 example) outgoing news and mail messages which are generated
8413 locally, you should use the file <file>/etc/mailname</file>. It
8414 will contain the portion after the username and <tt>@</tt>
8415 (at) sign for email addresses of users on the machine
8416 (followed by a newline).
8420 Such a package should check for the existence of this file
8421 when it is being configured. If it exists, it should be
8422 used without comment, although an MTA's configuration script
8423 may wish to prompt the user even if it finds that this file
8424 exists. If the file does not exist, the package should
8425 prompt the user for the value (preferably using
8426 <prgn>debconf</prgn>) and store it in <file>/etc/mailname</file>
8427 as well as using it in the package's configuration. The
8428 prompt should make it clear that the name will not just be
8429 used by that package. For example, in this situation the
8430 <tt>inn</tt> package could say something like:
8431 <example compact="compact">
8432 Please enter the "mail name" of your system. This is the
8433 hostname portion of the address to be shown on outgoing
8434 news and mail messages. The default is
8435 <var>syshostname</var>, your system's host name. Mail
8436 name ["<var>syshostname</var>"]:
8438 where <var>syshostname</var> is the output of <tt>hostname
8444 <heading>News system configuration</heading>
8447 All the configuration files related to the NNTP (news)
8448 servers and clients should be located under
8449 <file>/etc/news</file>.</p>
8452 There are some configuration issues that apply to a number
8453 of news clients and server packages on the machine. These
8457 <tag><file>/etc/news/organization</file></tag>
8459 A string which should appear as the
8460 organization header for all messages posted
8461 by NNTP clients on the machine
8464 <tag><file>/etc/news/server</file></tag>
8466 Contains the FQDN of the upstream NNTP
8467 server, or localhost if the local machine is
8472 Other global files may be added as required for cross-package news
8479 <heading>Programs for the X Window System</heading>
8482 <heading>Providing X support and package priorities</heading>
8485 Programs that can be configured with support for the X
8486 Window System must be configured to do so and must declare
8487 any package dependencies necessary to satisfy their
8488 runtime requirements when using the X Window System. If
8489 such a package is of higher priority than the X packages
8490 on which it depends, it is required that either the
8491 X-specific components be split into a separate package, or
8492 that an alternative version of the package, which includes
8493 X support, be provided, or that the package's priority be
8499 <heading>Packages providing an X server</heading>
8502 Packages that provide an X server that, directly or
8503 indirectly, communicates with real input and display
8504 hardware should declare in their control data that they
8505 provide the virtual package <tt>xserver</tt>.<footnote>
8506 This implements current practice, and provides an
8507 actual policy for usage of the <tt>xserver</tt>
8508 virtual package which appears in the virtual packages
8509 list. In a nutshell, X servers that interface
8510 directly with the display and input hardware or via
8511 another subsystem (e.g., GGI) should provide
8512 <tt>xserver</tt>. Things like <tt>Xvfb</tt>,
8513 <tt>Xnest</tt>, and <tt>Xprt</tt> should not.
8519 <heading>Packages providing a terminal emulator</heading>
8522 Packages that provide a terminal emulator for the X Window
8523 System which meet the criteria listed below should declare
8524 in their control data that they provide the virtual
8525 package <tt>x-terminal-emulator</tt>. They should also
8526 register themselves as an alternative for
8527 <file>/usr/bin/x-terminal-emulator</file>, with a priority of
8532 To be an <tt>x-terminal-emulator</tt>, a program must:
8533 <list compact="compact">
8535 Be able to emulate a DEC VT100 terminal, or a
8536 compatible terminal.
8540 Support the command-line option <tt>-e
8541 <var>command</var></tt>, which creates a new
8542 terminal window<footnote>
8543 "New terminal window" does not necessarily mean
8544 a new top-level X window directly parented by
8545 the window manager; it could, if the terminal
8546 emulator application were so coded, be a new
8547 "view" in a multiple-document interface (MDI).
8549 and runs the specified <var>command</var>,
8550 interpreting the entirety of the rest of the command
8551 line as a command to pass straight to exec, in the
8552 manner that <tt>xterm</tt> does.
8556 Support the command-line option <tt>-T
8557 <var>title</var></tt>, which creates a new terminal
8558 window with the window title <var>title</var>.
8565 <heading>Packages providing a window manager</heading>
8568 Packages that provide a window manager should declare in
8569 their control data that they provide the virtual package
8570 <tt>x-window-manager</tt>. They should also register
8571 themselves as an alternative for
8572 <file>/usr/bin/x-window-manager</file>, with a priority
8573 calculated as follows:
8574 <list compact="compact">
8576 Start with a priority of 20.
8580 If the window manager supports the Debian menu
8581 system, add 20 points if this support is available
8582 in the package's default configuration (i.e., no
8583 configuration files belonging to the system or user
8584 have to be edited to activate the feature); if
8585 configuration files must be modified, add only 10
8591 If the window manager complies with <url
8592 id="http://www.freedesktop.org/Standards/wm-spec"
8593 name="The Window Manager Specification Project">,
8594 written by the <url id="http://www.freedesktop.org/"
8595 name="Free Desktop Group">, add 40 points.
8599 If the window manager permits the X session to be
8600 restarted using a <em>different</em> window manager
8601 (without killing the X server) in its default
8602 configuration, add 10 points; otherwise add none.
8609 <heading>Packages providing fonts</heading>
8612 Packages that provide fonts for the X Window
8614 For the purposes of Debian Policy, a "font for the X
8615 Window System" is one which is accessed via X protocol
8616 requests. Fonts for the Linux console, for PostScript
8617 renderer, or any other purpose, do not fit this
8618 definition. Any tool which makes such fonts available
8619 to the X Window System, however, must abide by this
8622 must do a number of things to ensure that they are both
8623 available without modification of the X or font server
8624 configuration, and that they do not corrupt files used by
8625 other font packages to register information about
8629 Fonts of any type supported by the X Window System
8630 must be in a separate binary package from any
8631 executables, libraries, or documentation (except
8632 that specific to the fonts shipped, such as their
8633 license information). If one or more of the fonts
8634 so packaged are necessary for proper operation of
8635 the package with which they are associated the font
8636 package may be Recommended; if the fonts merely
8637 provide an enhancement, a Suggests relationship may
8638 be used. Packages must not Depend on font
8640 This is because the X server may retrieve fonts
8641 from the local file system or over the network
8642 from an X font server; the Debian package system
8643 is empowered to deal only with the local
8649 BDF fonts must be converted to PCF fonts with the
8650 <prgn>bdftopcf</prgn> utility (available in the
8651 <tt>xfonts-utils</tt> package, <prgn>gzip</prgn>ped, and
8652 placed in a directory that corresponds to their
8654 <list compact="compact">
8656 100 dpi fonts must be placed in
8657 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/100dpi/</file>.
8661 75 dpi fonts must be placed in
8662 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/75dpi/</file>.
8666 Character-cell fonts, cursor fonts, and other
8667 low-resolution fonts must be placed in
8668 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/misc/</file>.
8674 Type 1 fonts must be placed in
8675 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/Type1/</file>. If font
8676 metric files are available, they must be placed here
8681 Subdirectories of <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/</file>
8682 other than those listed above must be neither
8683 created nor used. (The <file>PEX</file>, <file>CID</file>,
8684 <file>Speedo</file>, and <file>cyrillic</file> directories
8685 are excepted for historical reasons, but installation of
8686 files into these directories remains discouraged.)
8690 Font packages may, instead of placing files directly
8691 in the X font directories listed above, provide
8692 symbolic links in that font directory pointing to
8693 the files' actual location in the filesystem. Such
8694 a location must comply with the FHS.
8698 Font packages should not contain both 75dpi and
8699 100dpi versions of a font. If both are available,
8700 they should be provided in separate binary packages
8701 with <tt>-75dpi</tt> or <tt>-100dpi</tt> appended to
8702 the names of the packages containing the
8703 corresponding fonts.
8707 Fonts destined for the <file>misc</file> subdirectory
8708 should not be included in the same package as 75dpi
8709 or 100dpi fonts; instead, they should be provided in
8710 a separate package with <tt>-misc</tt> appended to
8715 Font packages must not provide the files
8716 <file>fonts.dir</file>, <file>fonts.alias</file>, or
8717 <file>fonts.scale</file> in a font directory:
8720 <file>fonts.dir</file> files must not be provided at all.
8724 <file>fonts.alias</file> and <file>fonts.scale</file>
8725 files, if needed, should be provided in the
8727 <file>/etc/X11/fonts/<var>fontdir</var>/<var>package</var>.<var>extension</var></file>,
8728 where <var>fontdir</var> is the name of the
8730 <file>/usr/share/fonts/X11/</file> where the
8731 package's corresponding fonts are stored
8732 (e.g., <tt>75dpi</tt> or <tt>misc</tt>),
8733 <var>package</var> is the name of the package
8734 that provides these fonts, and
8735 <var>extension</var> is either <tt>scale</tt>
8736 or <tt>alias</tt>, whichever corresponds to
8743 Font packages must declare a dependency on
8744 <tt>xfonts-utils</tt> in their control
8749 Font packages that provide one or more
8750 <file>fonts.scale</file> files as described above must
8751 invoke <prgn>update-fonts-scale</prgn> on each
8752 directory into which they installed fonts
8753 <em>before</em> invoking
8754 <prgn>update-fonts-dir</prgn> on that directory.
8755 This invocation must occur in both the
8756 <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all arguments) and
8757 <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all arguments except
8758 <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
8762 Font packages that provide one or more
8763 <file>fonts.alias</file> files as described above must
8764 invoke <prgn>update-fonts-alias</prgn> on each
8765 directory into which they installed fonts. This
8766 invocation must occur in both the
8767 <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all arguments) and
8768 <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all arguments except
8769 <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
8773 Font packages must invoke
8774 <prgn>update-fonts-dir</prgn> on each directory into
8775 which they installed fonts. This invocation must
8776 occur in both the <prgn>postinst</prgn> (for all
8777 arguments) and <prgn>postrm</prgn> (for all
8778 arguments except <tt>upgrade</tt>) scripts.
8782 Font packages must not provide alias names for the
8783 fonts they include which collide with alias names
8784 already in use by fonts already packaged.
8788 Font packages must not provide fonts with the same
8789 XLFD registry name as another font already packaged.
8795 <sect1 id="appdefaults">
8796 <heading>Application defaults files</heading>
8799 Application defaults files must be installed in the
8800 directory <file>/etc/X11/app-defaults/</file> (use of a
8801 localized subdirectory of <file>/etc/X11/</file> as described
8802 in the <em>X Toolkit Intrinsics - C Language
8803 Interface</em> manual is also permitted). They must be
8804 registered as <tt>conffile</tt>s or handled as
8805 configuration files.
8809 Customization of programs' X resources may also be
8810 supported with the provision of a file with the same name
8811 as that of the package placed in
8812 the <file>/etc/X11/Xresources/</file> directory, which
8813 must be registered as a <tt>conffile</tt> or handled as a
8814 configuration file.<footnote>
8815 Note that this mechanism is not the same as using
8816 app-defaults; app-defaults are tied to the client
8817 binary on the local file system, whereas X resources
8818 are stored in the X server and affect all connecting
8825 <heading>Installation directory issues</heading>
8828 Historically, packages using the X Window System used a
8829 separate set of installation directories from other packages.
8830 This practice has been discontinued and packages using the X
8831 Window System should now generally be installed in the same
8832 directories as any other package. Specifically, packages must
8833 not install files under the <file>/usr/X11R6/</file> directory
8834 and the <file>/usr/X11R6/</file> directory hierarchy should be
8835 regarded as obsolete.
8839 Include files previously installed under
8840 <file>/usr/X11R6/include/X11/</file> should be installed into
8841 <file>/usr/include/X11/</file>. For files previously
8842 installed into subdirectories of
8843 <file>/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/</file>, package maintainers should
8844 determine if subdirectories of <file>/usr/lib/</file> and
8845 <file>/usr/share/</file> can be used. If not, a subdirectory
8846 of <file>/usr/lib/X11/</file> should be used.
8850 Configuration files for window, display, or session managers
8851 or other applications that are tightly integrated with the X
8852 Window System may be placed in a subdirectory
8853 of <file>/etc/X11/</file> corresponding to the package name.
8854 Other X Window System applications should use
8855 the <file>/etc/</file> directory unless otherwise mandated by
8856 policy (such as for <ref id="appdefaults">).
8861 <heading>The OSF/Motif and OpenMotif libraries</heading>
8864 <em>Programs that require the non-DFSG-compliant OSF/Motif or
8865 OpenMotif libraries</em><footnote>
8866 OSF/Motif and OpenMotif are collectively referred to as
8867 "Motif" in this policy document.
8869 should be compiled against and tested with LessTif (a free
8870 re-implementation of Motif) instead. If the maintainer
8871 judges that the program or programs do not work
8872 sufficiently well with LessTif to be distributed and
8873 supported, but do so when compiled against Motif, then two
8874 versions of the package should be created; one linked
8875 statically against Motif and with <tt>-smotif</tt>
8876 appended to the package name, and one linked dynamically
8877 against Motif and with <tt>-dmotif</tt> appended to the
8882 Both Motif-linked versions are dependent
8883 upon non-DFSG-compliant software and thus cannot be
8884 uploaded to the <em>main</em> distribution; if the
8885 software is itself DFSG-compliant it may be uploaded to
8886 the <em>contrib</em> distribution. While known existing
8887 versions of Motif permit unlimited redistribution of
8888 binaries linked against the library (whether statically or
8889 dynamically), it is the package maintainer's
8890 responsibility to determine whether this is permitted by
8891 the license of the copy of Motif in their possession.
8897 <heading>Perl programs and modules</heading>
8900 Perl programs and modules should follow the current Perl policy.
8904 The Perl policy can be found in the <tt>perl-policy</tt>
8905 files in the <tt>debian-policy</tt> package.
8906 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
8907 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/perl-policy/"
8908 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/perl-policy/"></tt>.
8913 <heading>Emacs lisp programs</heading>
8916 Please refer to the "Debian Emacs Policy" for details of how to
8917 package emacs lisp programs.
8921 The Emacs policy is available in
8922 <file>debian-emacs-policy.gz</file> of the
8923 <package>emacsen-common</package> package.
8924 It is also available from the Debian web mirrors at
8925 <tt><url name="/doc/packaging-manuals/debian-emacs-policy"
8926 id="http://www.debian.org/doc/packaging-manuals/debian-emacs-policy"></tt>.
8931 <heading>Games</heading>
8934 The permissions on <file>/var/games</file> are mode 755, owner
8935 <tt>root</tt> and group <tt>root</tt>.
8939 Each game decides on its own security policy.</p>
8942 Games which require protected, privileged access to
8943 high-score files, saved games, etc., may be made
8944 set-<em>group</em>-id (mode 2755) and owned by
8945 <tt>root:games</tt>, and use files and directories with
8946 appropriate permissions (770 <tt>root:games</tt>, for
8947 example). They must not be made
8948 set-<em>user</em>-id, as this causes security problems. (If
8949 an attacker can subvert any set-user-id game they can
8950 overwrite the executable of any other, causing other players
8951 of these games to run a Trojan horse program. With a
8952 set-group-id game the attacker only gets access to less
8953 important game data, and if they can get at the other
8954 players' accounts at all it will take considerably more
8958 Some packages, for example some fortune cookie programs, are
8959 configured by the upstream authors to install with their
8960 data files or other static information made unreadable so
8961 that they can only be accessed through set-id programs
8962 provided. You should not do this in a Debian package: anyone can
8963 download the <file>.deb</file> file and read the data from it,
8964 so there is no point making the files unreadable. Not
8965 making the files unreadable also means that you don't have
8966 to make so many programs set-id, which reduces the risk of a
8970 As described in the FHS, binaries of games should be
8971 installed in the directory <file>/usr/games</file>. This also
8972 applies to games that use the X Window System. Manual pages
8973 for games (X and non-X games) should be installed in
8974 <file>/usr/share/man/man6</file>.</p>
8980 <heading>Documentation</heading>
8983 <heading>Manual pages</heading>
8986 You should install manual pages in <prgn>nroff</prgn> source
8987 form, in appropriate places under <file>/usr/share/man</file>.
8988 You should only use sections 1 to 9 (see the FHS for more
8989 details). You must not install a pre-formatted "cat page".
8993 Each program, utility, and function should have an
8994 associated manual page included in the same package. It is
8995 suggested that all configuration files also have a manual
8996 page included as well. Manual pages for protocols and other
8997 auxiliary things are optional.
9001 If no manual page is available, this is considered as a bug
9002 and should be reported to the Debian Bug Tracking System (the
9003 maintainer of the package is allowed to write this bug report
9004 themselves, if they so desire). Do not close the bug report
9005 until a proper man page is available.<footnote>
9006 It is not very hard to write a man page. See the
9007 <url id="http://www.schweikhardt.net/man_page_howto.html"
9008 name="Man-Page-HOWTO">,
9009 <manref name="man" section="7">, the examples
9010 created by <prgn>debmake</prgn> or <prgn>dh_make</prgn>,
9011 the helper program <prgn>help2man</prgn>, or the
9012 directory <file>/usr/share/doc/man-db/examples</file>.
9017 You may forward a complaint about a missing man page to the
9018 upstream authors, and mark the bug as forwarded in the
9019 Debian bug tracking system. Even though the GNU Project do
9020 not in general consider the lack of a man page to be a bug,
9021 we do; if they tell you that they don't consider it a bug
9022 you should leave the bug in our bug tracking system open
9027 Manual pages should be installed compressed using <tt>gzip -9</tt>.
9031 If one man page needs to be accessible via several names it
9032 is better to use a symbolic link than the <file>.so</file>
9033 feature, but there is no need to fiddle with the relevant
9034 parts of the upstream source to change from <file>.so</file> to
9035 symlinks: don't do it unless it's easy. You should not
9036 create hard links in the manual page directories, nor put
9037 absolute filenames in <file>.so</file> directives. The filename
9038 in a <file>.so</file> in a man page should be relative to the
9039 base of the man page tree (usually
9040 <file>/usr/share/man</file>). If you do not create any links
9041 (whether symlinks, hard links, or <tt>.so</tt> directives)
9042 in the file system to the alternate names of the man page,
9043 then you should not rely on <prgn>man</prgn> finding your
9044 man page under those names based solely on the information in
9045 the man page's header.<footnote>
9046 Supporting this in <prgn>man</prgn> often requires
9047 unreasonable processing time to find a manual page or to
9048 report that none exists, and moves knowledge into man's
9049 database that would be better left in the file system.
9050 This support is therefore deprecated and will cease to
9051 be present in the future.
9056 Manual pages in locale-specific subdirectories of
9057 <file>/usr/share/man</file> should use either UTF-8 or the usual
9058 legacy encoding for that language (normally the one corresponding
9059 to the shortest relevant locale name in
9060 <file>/usr/share/i18n/SUPPORTED</file>). For example, pages under
9061 <file>/usr/share/man/fr</file> should use either UTF-8 or
9062 ISO-8859-1.<footnote>
9063 <prgn>man</prgn> will automatically detect whether UTF-8 is in
9064 use. In future, all manual pages will be required to use
9070 A country name (the <tt>DE</tt> in <tt>de_DE</tt>) should not be
9071 included in the subdirectory name unless it indicates a
9072 significant difference in the language, as this excludes
9073 speakers of the language in other countries.<footnote>
9074 At the time of writing, Chinese and Portuguese are the main
9075 languages with such differences, so <file>pt_BR</file>,
9076 <file>zh_CN</file>, and <file>zh_TW</file> are all allowed.
9081 If a localized version of a manual page is provided, it should
9082 either be up-to-date or it should be obvious to the reader that
9083 it is outdated and the original manual page should be used
9084 instead. This can be done either by a note at the beginning of
9085 the manual page or by showing the missing or changed portions in
9086 the original language instead of the target language.
9091 <heading>Info documents</heading>
9094 Info documents should be installed in <file>/usr/share/info</file>.
9095 They should be compressed with <tt>gzip -9</tt>.
9099 The <prgn>install-info</prgn> program maintains a directory of
9100 installed info documents in <file>/usr/share/info/dir</file> for
9101 the use of info readers.<footnote>
9102 It was previously necessary for packages installing info
9103 documents to run <prgn>install-info</prgn> from maintainer
9104 scripts. This is no longer necessary. The installation
9105 system now uses dpkg triggers.
9107 This file must not be included in packages. Packages containing
9108 info documents should depend on <tt>dpkg (>= 1.15.4) |
9109 install-info</tt> to ensure that the directory file is properly
9110 rebuilt during partial upgrades from Debian 5.0 (lenny) and
9115 Info documents should contain section and directory entry
9116 information in the document for the use
9117 of <prgn>install-info</prgn>. The section should be specified
9118 via a line starting with <tt>INFO-DIR-SECTION</tt> followed by a
9119 space and the section of this info page. The directory entry or
9120 entries should be included between
9121 a <tt>START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY</tt> line and
9122 an <tt>END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY</tt> line. For example:
9124 INFO-DIR-SECTION Individual utilities
9125 START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY
9126 * example: (example). An example info directory entry.
9129 To determine which section to use, you should look
9130 at <file>/usr/share/info/dir</file> on your system and choose
9131 the most relevant (or create a new section if none of the
9132 current sections are relevant).<footnote>
9133 Normally, info documents are generated from Texinfo source.
9134 To include this information in the generated info document, if
9135 it is absent, add commands like:
9137 @dircategory Individual utilities
9139 * example: (example). An example info directory entry.
9142 to the Texinfo source of the document and ensure that the info
9143 documents are rebuilt from source during the package build.
9149 <heading>Additional documentation</heading>
9152 Any additional documentation that comes with the package may
9153 be installed at the discretion of the package maintainer.
9154 Plain text documentation should be installed in the directory
9155 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>, where
9156 <var>package</var> is the name of the package, and
9157 compressed with <tt>gzip -9</tt> unless it is small.
9161 If a package comes with large amounts of documentation which
9162 many users of the package will not require you should create
9163 a separate binary package to contain it, so that it does not
9164 take up disk space on the machines of users who do not need
9165 or want it installed.</p>
9168 It is often a good idea to put text information files
9169 (<file>README</file>s, changelogs, and so forth) that come with
9170 the source package in <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>
9171 in the binary package. However, you don't need to install
9172 the instructions for building and installing the package, of
9176 Packages must not require the existence of any files in
9177 <file>/usr/share/doc/</file> in order to function
9179 The system administrator should be able to
9180 delete files in <file>/usr/share/doc/</file> without causing
9181 any programs to break.
9183 Any files that are referenced by programs but are also
9184 useful as stand alone documentation should be installed under
9185 <file>/usr/share/<var>package</var>/</file> with symbolic links from
9186 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>.
9190 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> may be a symbolic
9191 link to another directory in <file>/usr/share/doc</file> only if
9192 the two packages both come from the same source and the
9193 first package Depends on the second.<footnote>
9195 Please note that this does not override the section on
9196 changelog files below, so the file
9197 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.Debian.gz</file>
9198 must refer to the changelog for the current version of
9199 <var>package</var> in question. In practice, this means
9200 that the sources of the target and the destination of the
9201 symlink must be the same (same source package and
9208 Former Debian releases placed all additional documentation
9209 in <file>/usr/doc/<var>package</var></file>. This has been
9210 changed to <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>,
9211 and packages must not put documentation in the directory
9212 <file>/usr/doc/<var>package</var></file>. <footnote>
9213 At this phase of the transition, we no longer require a
9214 symbolic link in <file>/usr/doc/</file>. At a later point,
9215 policy shall change to make the symbolic links a bug.
9221 <heading>Preferred documentation formats</heading>
9224 The unification of Debian documentation is being carried out
9228 If your package comes with extensive documentation in a
9229 markup format that can be converted to various other formats
9230 you should if possible ship HTML versions in a binary
9231 package, in the directory
9232 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>appropriate-package</var></file> or
9233 its subdirectories.<footnote>
9234 The rationale: The important thing here is that HTML
9235 docs should be available in <em>some</em> package, not
9236 necessarily in the main binary package.
9241 Other formats such as PostScript may be provided at the
9242 package maintainer's discretion.
9246 <sect id="copyrightfile">
9247 <heading>Copyright information</heading>
9250 Every package must be accompanied by a verbatim copy of its
9251 copyright information and distribution license in the file
9252 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file>. This
9253 file must neither be compressed nor be a symbolic link.
9257 In addition, the copyright file must say where the upstream
9258 sources (if any) were obtained. It should name the original
9259 authors of the package and the Debian maintainer(s) who were
9260 involved with its creation.
9264 Packages in the <em>contrib</em> or <em>non-free</em> archive
9265 areas should state in the copyright file that the package is not
9266 part of the Debian GNU/Linux distribution and briefly explain
9271 A copy of the file which will be installed in
9272 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/copyright</file> should
9273 be in <file>debian/copyright</file> in the source package.
9277 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> may be a symbolic
9278 link to another directory in <file>/usr/share/doc</file> only if
9279 the two packages both come from the same source and the
9280 first package Depends on the second. These rules are
9281 important because copyrights must be extractable by
9286 Packages distributed under the Apache license (version 2.0), the
9287 Artistic license, the GNU GPL (version 2 or 3), the GNU LGPL
9288 (versions 2, 2.1, or 3), and the GNU FDL (versions 1.2 or 1.3)
9289 should refer to the corresponding files
9290 under <file>/usr/share/common-licenses</file>,<footnote>
9293 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/Apache-2.0</file>,
9294 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/Artistic</file>,
9295 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-2</file>,
9296 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GPL-3</file>,
9297 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-2</file>,
9298 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-2.1</file>,
9299 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/LGPL-3</file>,
9300 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GFDL-1.2</file>, and
9301 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/GFDL-1.3</file>
9302 respectively. The University of California BSD license is
9303 also included in <package>base-files</package> as
9304 <file>/usr/share/common-licenses/BSD</file>, but given the
9305 brevity of this license, its specificity to code whose
9306 copyright is held by the Regents of the University of
9307 California, and the frequency of minor wording changes, its
9308 text should be included in the copyright file rather than
9309 referencing this file.
9311 </footnote> rather than quoting them in the copyright
9316 You should not use the copyright file as a general <file>README</file>
9317 file. If your package has such a file it should be
9318 installed in <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/README</file> or
9319 <file>README.Debian</file> or some other appropriate place.</p>
9323 <heading>Examples</heading>
9326 Any examples (configurations, source files, whatever),
9327 should be installed in a directory
9328 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file>. These
9329 files should not be referenced by any program: they're there
9330 for the benefit of the system administrator and users as
9331 documentation only. Architecture-specific example files
9332 should be installed in a directory
9333 <file>/usr/lib/<var>package</var>/examples</file> with symbolic
9335 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/examples</file>, or the
9336 latter directory itself may be a symbolic link to the
9341 If the purpose of a package is to provide examples, then the
9342 example files may be installed into
9343 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file>.
9347 <sect id="changelogs">
9348 <heading>Changelog files</heading>
9351 Packages that are not Debian-native must contain a
9352 compressed copy of the <file>debian/changelog</file> file from
9353 the Debian source tree in
9354 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var></file> with the name
9355 <file>changelog.Debian.gz</file>.
9359 If an upstream changelog is available, it should be accessible as
9360 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.gz</file> in
9361 plain text. If the upstream changelog is distributed in
9362 HTML, it should be made available in that form as
9363 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.html.gz</file>
9364 and a plain text <file>changelog.gz</file> should be generated
9365 from it using, for example, <tt>lynx -dump -nolist</tt>. If
9366 the upstream changelog files do not already conform to this
9367 naming convention, then this may be achieved either by
9368 renaming the files, or by adding a symbolic link, at the
9369 maintainer's discretion.<footnote>
9370 Rationale: People should not have to look in places for
9371 upstream changelogs merely because they are given
9372 different names or are distributed in HTML format.
9377 All of these files should be installed compressed using
9378 <tt>gzip -9</tt>, as they will become large with time even
9379 if they start out small.
9383 If the package has only one changelog which is used both as
9384 the Debian changelog and the upstream one because there is
9385 no separate upstream maintainer then that changelog should
9386 usually be installed as
9387 <file>/usr/share/doc/<var>package</var>/changelog.gz</file>; if
9388 there is a separate upstream maintainer, but no upstream
9389 changelog, then the Debian changelog should still be called
9390 <file>changelog.Debian.gz</file>.
9394 For details about the format and contents of the Debian
9395 changelog file, please see <ref id="dpkgchangelog">.
9400 <appendix id="pkg-scope">
9401 <heading>Introduction and scope of these appendices</heading>
9404 These appendices are taken essentially verbatim from the
9405 now-deprecated Packaging Manual, version 3.2.1.0. They are
9406 the chapters which are likely to be of use to package
9407 maintainers and which have not already been included in the
9408 policy document itself. Most of these sections are very likely
9409 not relevant to policy; they should be treated as
9410 documentation for the packaging system. Please note that these
9411 appendices are included for convenience, and for historical
9412 reasons: they used to be part of policy package, and they have
9413 not yet been incorporated into dpkg documentation. However,
9414 they still have value, and hence they are presented here.
9418 They have not yet been checked to ensure that they are
9419 compatible with the contents of policy, and if there are any
9420 contradictions, the version in the main policy document takes
9421 precedence. The remaining chapters of the old Packaging
9422 Manual have also not been read in detail to ensure that there
9423 are not parts which have been left out. Both of these will be
9428 Certain parts of the Packaging manual were integrated into the
9429 Policy Manual proper, and removed from the appendices. Links
9430 have been placed from the old locations to the new ones.
9434 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> is a suite of programs for creating binary
9435 package files and installing and removing them on Unix
9437 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> is targeted primarily at Debian
9438 GNU/Linux, but may work on or be ported to other
9444 The binary packages are designed for the management of
9445 installed executable programs (usually compiled binaries) and
9446 their associated data, though source code examples and
9447 documentation are provided as part of some packages.</p>
9450 This manual describes the technical aspects of creating Debian
9451 binary packages (<file>.deb</file> files). It documents the
9452 behavior of the package management programs
9453 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>, <prgn>dselect</prgn> et al. and the way
9454 they interact with packages.</p>
9457 It also documents the interaction between
9458 <prgn>dselect</prgn>'s core and the access method scripts it
9459 uses to actually install the selected packages, and describes
9460 how to create a new access method.</p>
9463 This manual does not go into detail about the options and
9464 usage of the package building and installation tools. It
9465 should therefore be read in conjunction with those programs'
9470 The utility programs which are provided with <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
9471 for managing various system configuration and similar issues,
9472 such as <prgn>update-rc.d</prgn> and
9473 <prgn>install-info</prgn>, are not described in detail here -
9474 please see their man pages.
9478 It is assumed that the reader is reasonably familiar with the
9479 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> System Administrators' manual.
9480 Unfortunately this manual does not yet exist.
9484 The Debian version of the FSF's GNU hello program is provided
9485 as an example for people wishing to create Debian
9486 packages. The Debian <prgn>debmake</prgn> package is
9487 recommended as a very helpful tool in creating and maintaining
9488 Debian packages. However, while the tools and examples are
9489 helpful, they do not replace the need to read and follow the
9490 Policy and Programmer's Manual.</p>
9493 <appendix id="pkg-binarypkg">
9494 <heading>Binary packages (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
9497 The binary package has two main sections. The first part
9498 consists of various control information files and scripts used
9499 by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when installing and removing. See <ref
9500 id="pkg-controlarea">.
9504 The second part is an archive containing the files and
9505 directories to be installed.
9509 In the future binary packages may also contain other
9510 components, such as checksums and digital signatures. The
9511 format for the archive is described in full in the
9512 <file>deb(5)</file> man page.
9516 <sect id="pkg-bincreating"><heading>Creating package files -
9517 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn>
9521 All manipulation of binary package files is done by
9522 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn>; it's the only program that has
9523 knowledge of the format. (<prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> may be
9524 invoked by calling <prgn>dpkg</prgn>, as <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
9525 will spot that the options requested are appropriate to
9526 <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> and invoke that instead with the same
9531 In order to create a binary package you must make a
9532 directory tree which contains all the files and directories
9533 you want to have in the file system data part of the package.
9534 In Debian-format source packages this directory is usually
9535 <file>debian/tmp</file>, relative to the top of the package's
9540 They should have the locations (relative to the root of the
9541 directory tree you're constructing) ownerships and
9542 permissions which you want them to have on the system when
9547 With current versions of <prgn>dpkg</prgn> the uid/username
9548 and gid/groupname mappings for the users and groups being
9549 used should be the same on the system where the package is
9550 built and the one where it is installed.
9554 You need to add one special directory to the root of the
9555 miniature file system tree you're creating:
9556 <prgn>DEBIAN</prgn>. It should contain the control
9557 information files, notably the binary package control file
9558 (see <ref id="pkg-controlfile">).
9562 The <prgn>DEBIAN</prgn> directory will not appear in the
9563 file system archive of the package, and so won't be installed
9564 by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when the package is installed.
9568 When you've prepared the package, you should invoke:
9570 dpkg --build <var>directory</var>
9575 This will build the package in
9576 <file><var>directory</var>.deb</file>. (<prgn>dpkg</prgn> knows
9577 that <tt>--build</tt> is a <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> option, so
9578 it invokes <prgn>dpkg-deb</prgn> with the same arguments to
9583 See the man page <manref name="dpkg-deb" section="8"> for details of how
9584 to examine the contents of this newly-created file. You may find the
9585 output of following commands enlightening:
9587 dpkg-deb --info <var>filename</var>.deb
9588 dpkg-deb --contents <var>filename</var>.deb
9589 dpkg --contents <var>filename</var>.deb
9591 To view the copyright file for a package you could use this command:
9593 dpkg --fsys-tarfile <var>filename</var>.deb | tar xOf - --wildcards \*/copyright | pager
9598 <sect id="pkg-controlarea">
9599 <heading>Package control information files</heading>
9602 The control information portion of a binary package is a
9603 collection of files with names known to <prgn>dpkg</prgn>.
9604 It will treat the contents of these files specially - some
9605 of them contain information used by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when
9606 installing or removing the package; others are scripts which
9607 the package maintainer wants <prgn>dpkg</prgn> to run.
9611 It is possible to put other files in the package control
9612 area, but this is not generally a good idea (though they
9613 will largely be ignored).
9617 Here is a brief list of the control info files supported by
9618 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> and a summary of what they're used for.
9623 <tag><tt>control</tt>
9626 This is the key description file used by
9627 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. It specifies the package's name
9628 and version, gives its description for the user,
9629 states its relationships with other packages, and so
9630 forth. See <ref id="sourcecontrolfiles"> and
9631 <ref id="binarycontrolfiles">.
9635 It is usually generated automatically from information
9636 in the source package by the
9637 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> program, and with
9638 assistance from <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>.
9639 See <ref id="pkg-sourcetools">.
9643 <tag><tt>postinst</tt>, <tt>preinst</tt>, <tt>postrm</tt>,
9648 These are executable files (usually scripts) which
9649 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> runs during installation, upgrade
9650 and removal of packages. They allow the package to
9651 deal with matters which are particular to that package
9652 or require more complicated processing than that
9653 provided by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>. Details of when and
9654 how they are called are in <ref id="maintainerscripts">.
9658 It is very important to make these scripts idempotent.
9659 See <ref id="idempotency">.
9663 The maintainer scripts are not guaranteed to run with a
9664 controlling terminal and may not be able to interact with
9665 the user. See <ref id="controllingterminal">.
9669 <tag><tt>conffiles</tt>
9672 This file contains a list of configuration files which
9673 are to be handled automatically by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>
9674 (see <ref id="pkg-conffiles">). Note that not necessarily
9675 every configuration file should be listed here.
9678 <tag><tt>shlibs</tt>
9681 This file contains a list of the shared libraries
9682 supplied by the package, with dependency details for
9683 each. This is used by <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn>
9684 when it determines what dependencies are required in a
9685 package control file. The <tt>shlibs</tt> file format
9686 is described on <ref id="shlibs">.
9691 <sect id="pkg-controlfile">
9692 <heading>The main control information file: <tt>control</tt></heading>
9695 The most important control information file used by
9696 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> when it installs a package is
9697 <tt>control</tt>. It contains all the package's "vital
9702 The binary package control files of packages built from
9703 Debian sources are made by a special tool,
9704 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>, which reads
9705 <file>debian/control</file> and <file>debian/changelog</file> to
9706 find the information it needs. See <ref id="pkg-sourcepkg"> for
9711 The fields in binary package control files are listed in
9712 <ref id="binarycontrolfiles">.
9716 A description of the syntax of control files and the purpose
9717 of the fields is available in <ref id="controlfields">.
9722 <heading>Time Stamps</heading>
9725 See <ref id="timestamps">.
9730 <appendix id="pkg-sourcepkg">
9731 <heading>Source packages (from old Packaging Manual) </heading>
9734 The Debian binary packages in the distribution are generated
9735 from Debian sources, which are in a special format to assist
9736 the easy and automatic building of binaries.
9739 <sect id="pkg-sourcetools">
9740 <heading>Tools for processing source packages</heading>
9743 Various tools are provided for manipulating source packages;
9744 they pack and unpack sources and help build of binary
9745 packages and help manage the distribution of new versions.
9749 They are introduced and typical uses described here; see
9750 <manref name="dpkg-source" section="1"> for full
9751 documentation about their arguments and operation.
9755 For examples of how to construct a Debian source package,
9756 and how to use those utilities that are used by Debian
9757 source packages, please see the <prgn>hello</prgn> example
9761 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-source">
9763 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> - packs and unpacks Debian source
9768 This program is frequently used by hand, and is also
9769 called from package-independent automated building scripts
9770 such as <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>.
9774 To unpack a package it is typically invoked with
9776 dpkg-source -x <var>.../path/to/filename</var>.dsc
9781 with the <file><var>filename</var>.tar.gz</file> and
9782 <file><var>filename</var>.diff.gz</file> (if applicable) in
9783 the same directory. It unpacks into
9784 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>, and if
9786 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var>.orig</file>, in
9787 the current directory.
9791 To create a packed source archive it is typically invoked:
9793 dpkg-source -b <var>package</var>-<var>version</var>
9798 This will create the <file>.dsc</file>, <file>.tar.gz</file> and
9799 <file>.diff.gz</file> (if appropriate) in the current
9800 directory. <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> does not clean the
9801 source tree first - this must be done separately if it is
9806 See also <ref id="pkg-sourcearchives">.</p>
9810 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-buildpackage">
9812 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> - overall package-building
9817 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn> is a script which invokes
9818 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>, the <file>debian/rules</file>
9819 targets <tt>clean</tt>, <tt>build</tt> and
9820 <tt>binary</tt>, <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> and
9821 <prgn>gpg</prgn> (or <prgn>pgp</prgn>) to build a signed
9822 source and binary package upload.
9826 It is usually invoked by hand from the top level of the
9827 built or unbuilt source directory. It may be invoked with
9828 no arguments; useful arguments include:
9829 <taglist compact="compact">
9830 <tag><tt>-uc</tt>, <tt>-us</tt></tag>
9833 Do not sign the <tt>.changes</tt> file or the
9834 source package <tt>.dsc</tt> file, respectively.</p>
9836 <tag><tt>-p<var>sign-command</var></tt></tag>
9839 Invoke <var>sign-command</var> instead of finding
9840 <tt>gpg</tt> or <tt>pgp</tt> on the <prgn>PATH</prgn>.
9841 <var>sign-command</var> must behave just like
9842 <prgn>gpg</prgn> or <tt>pgp</tt>.</p>
9844 <tag><tt>-r<var>root-command</var></tt></tag>
9847 When root privilege is required, invoke the command
9848 <var>root-command</var>. <var>root-command</var>
9849 should invoke its first argument as a command, from
9850 the <prgn>PATH</prgn> if necessary, and pass its
9851 second and subsequent arguments to the command it
9852 calls. If no <var>root-command</var> is supplied
9853 then <var>dpkg-buildpackage</var> will take no
9854 special action to gain root privilege, so that for
9855 most packages it will have to be invoked as root to
9858 <tag><tt>-b</tt>, <tt>-B</tt></tag>
9861 Two types of binary-only build and upload - see
9862 <manref name="dpkg-source" section="1">.
9869 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-gencontrol">
9871 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> - generates binary package
9876 This program is usually called from <file>debian/rules</file>
9877 (see <ref id="pkg-sourcetree">) in the top level of the source
9882 This is usually done just before the files and directories in the
9883 temporary directory tree where the package is being built have their
9884 permissions and ownerships set and the package is constructed using
9885 <prgn>dpkg-deb/</prgn>
9887 This is so that the control file which is produced has
9888 the right permissions
9893 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> must be called after all the
9894 files which are to go into the package have been placed in
9895 the temporary build directory, so that its calculation of
9896 the installed size of a package is correct.
9900 It is also necessary for <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> to
9901 be run after <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> so that the
9902 variable substitutions created by
9903 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> in <file>debian/substvars</file>
9908 For a package which generates only one binary package, and
9909 which builds it in <file>debian/tmp</file> relative to the top
9910 of the source package, it is usually sufficient to call
9911 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn>.
9915 Sources which build several binaries will typically need
9918 dpkg-gencontrol -Pdebian/tmp-<var>pkg</var> -p<var>package</var>
9919 </example> The <tt>-P</tt> tells
9920 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> that the package is being
9921 built in a non-default directory, and the <tt>-p</tt>
9922 tells it which package's control file should be generated.
9926 <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> also adds information to the
9927 list of files in <file>debian/files</file>, for the benefit of
9928 (for example) a future invocation of
9929 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn>.</p>
9932 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-shlibdeps">
9934 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> - calculates shared library
9939 This program is usually called from <file>debian/rules</file>
9940 just before <prgn>dpkg-gencontrol</prgn> (see <ref
9941 id="pkg-sourcetree">), in the top level of the source tree.
9945 Its arguments are executables and shared libraries
9948 They may be specified either in the locations in the
9949 source tree where they are created or in the locations
9950 in the temporary build tree where they are installed
9951 prior to binary package creation.
9953 </footnote> for which shared library dependencies should
9954 be included in the binary package's control file.
9958 If some of the found shared libraries should only
9959 warrant a <tt>Recommends</tt> or <tt>Suggests</tt>, or if
9960 some warrant a <tt>Pre-Depends</tt>, this can be achieved
9961 by using the <tt>-d<var>dependency-field</var></tt> option
9962 before those executable(s). (Each <tt>-d</tt> option
9963 takes effect until the next <tt>-d</tt>.)
9967 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> does not directly cause the
9968 output control file to be modified. Instead by default it
9969 adds to the <file>debian/substvars</file> file variable
9970 settings like <tt>shlibs:Depends</tt>. These variable
9971 settings must be referenced in dependency fields in the
9972 appropriate per-binary-package sections of the source
9977 For example, a package that generates an essential part
9978 which requires dependencies, and optional parts that
9979 which only require a recommendation, would separate those
9980 two sets of dependencies into two different fields.<footnote>
9981 At the time of writing, an example for this was the
9982 <package/xmms/ package, with Depends used for the xmms
9983 executable, Recommends for the plug-ins and Suggests for
9984 even more optional features provided by unzip.
9986 It can say in its <file>debian/rules</file>:
9988 dpkg-shlibdeps -dDepends <var>program anotherprogram ...</var> \
9989 -dRecommends <var>optionalpart anotheroptionalpart</var>
9991 and then in its main control file <file>debian/control</file>:
9994 Depends: ${shlibs:Depends}
9995 Recommends: ${shlibs:Recommends}
10001 Sources which produce several binary packages with
10002 different shared library dependency requirements can use
10003 the <tt>-p<var>varnameprefix</var></tt> option to override
10004 the default <tt>shlibs:</tt> prefix (one invocation of
10005 <prgn>dpkg-shlibdeps</prgn> per setting of this option).
10006 They can thus produce several sets of dependency
10007 variables, each of the form
10008 <tt><var>varnameprefix</var>:<var>dependencyfield</var></tt>,
10009 which can be referred to in the appropriate parts of the
10010 binary package control files.
10015 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-distaddfile">
10017 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> - adds a file to
10018 <file>debian/files</file>
10022 Some packages' uploads need to include files other than
10023 the source and binary package files.
10027 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn> adds a file to the
10028 <file>debian/files</file> file so that it will be included in
10029 the <file>.changes</file> file when
10030 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> is run.
10034 It is usually invoked from the <tt>binary</tt> target of
10035 <file>debian/rules</file>:
10037 dpkg-distaddfile <var>filename</var> <var>section</var> <var>priority</var>
10039 The <var>filename</var> is relative to the directory where
10040 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> will expect to find it - this
10041 is usually the directory above the top level of the source
10042 tree. The <file>debian/rules</file> target should put the
10043 file there just before or just after calling
10044 <prgn>dpkg-distaddfile</prgn>.
10048 The <var>section</var> and <var>priority</var> are passed
10049 unchanged into the resulting <file>.changes</file> file.
10054 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-genchanges">
10056 <prgn>dpkg-genchanges</prgn> - generates a <file>.changes</file>
10057 upload control file
10061 This program is usually called by package-independent
10062 automatic building scripts such as
10063 <prgn>dpkg-buildpackage</prgn>, but it may also be called
10068 It is usually called in the top level of a built source
10069 tree, and when invoked with no arguments will print out a
10070 straightforward <file>.changes</file> file based on the
10071 information in the source package's changelog and control
10072 file and the binary and source packages which should have
10078 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-parsechangelog">
10080 <prgn>dpkg-parsechangelog</prgn> - produces parsed
10081 representation of a changelog
10085 This program is used internally by
10086 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> et al. It may also occasionally
10087 be useful in <file>debian/rules</file> and elsewhere. It
10088 parses a changelog, <file>debian/changelog</file> by default,
10089 and prints a control-file format representation of the
10090 information in it to standard output.
10094 <sect1 id="pkg-dpkg-architecture">
10096 <prgn>dpkg-architecture</prgn> - information about the build and
10101 This program can be used manually, but is also invoked by
10102 <tt>dpkg-buildpackage</tt> or <file>debian/rules</file> to set
10103 environment or make variables which specify the build and host
10104 architecture for the package building process.
10109 <sect id="pkg-sourcetree">
10110 <heading>The Debianised source tree</heading>
10113 The source archive scheme described later is intended to
10114 allow a Debianised source tree with some associated control
10115 information to be reproduced and transported easily. The
10116 Debianised source tree is a version of the original program
10117 with certain files added for the benefit of the
10118 Debianisation process, and with any other changes required
10119 made to the rest of the source code and installation
10124 The extra files created for Debian are in the subdirectory
10125 <file>debian</file> of the top level of the Debianised source
10126 tree. They are described below.
10129 <sect1 id="pkg-debianrules">
10130 <heading><file>debian/rules</file> - the main building script</heading>
10133 See <ref id="debianrules">.
10137 <sect1 id="pkg-srcsubstvars">
10138 <heading><file>debian/substvars</file> and variable substitutions</heading>
10141 See <ref id="substvars">.
10147 <heading><file>debian/files</file></heading>
10150 See <ref id="debianfiles">.
10154 <sect1><heading><file>debian/tmp</file>
10158 This is the canonical temporary location for the
10159 construction of binary packages by the <tt>binary</tt>
10160 target. The directory <file>tmp</file> serves as the root of
10161 the file system tree as it is being constructed (for
10162 example, by using the package's upstream makefiles install
10163 targets and redirecting the output there), and it also
10164 contains the <tt>DEBIAN</tt> subdirectory. See <ref
10165 id="pkg-bincreating">.
10169 If several binary packages are generated from the same
10170 source tree it is usual to use several
10171 <file>debian/tmp<var>something</var></file> directories, for
10172 example <file>tmp-a</file> or <file>tmp-doc</file>.
10176 Whatever <file>tmp</file> directories are created and used by
10177 <tt>binary</tt> must of course be removed by the
10178 <tt>clean</tt> target.</p></sect1>
10182 <sect id="pkg-sourcearchives"><heading>Source packages as archives
10186 As it exists on the FTP site, a Debian source package
10187 consists of three related files. You must have the right
10188 versions of all three to be able to use them.
10193 <tag>Debian source control file - <tt>.dsc</tt></tag>
10195 This file is a control file used by <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>
10196 to extract a source package.
10197 See <ref id="debiansourcecontrolfiles">.
10201 Original source archive -
10203 <var>package</var>_<var>upstream-version</var>.orig.tar.gz
10209 This is a compressed (with <tt>gzip -9</tt>)
10210 <prgn>tar</prgn> file containing the source code from
10211 the upstream authors of the program.
10216 Debianisation diff -
10218 <var>package</var>_<var>upstream_version-revision</var>.diff.gz
10224 This is a unified context diff (<tt>diff -u</tt>)
10225 giving the changes which are required to turn the
10226 original source into the Debian source. These changes
10227 may only include editing and creating plain files.
10228 The permissions of files, the targets of symbolic
10229 links and the characteristics of special files or
10230 pipes may not be changed and no files may be removed
10235 All the directories in the diff must exist, except the
10236 <file>debian</file> subdirectory of the top of the source
10237 tree, which will be created by
10238 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> if necessary when unpacking.
10242 The <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> program will
10243 automatically make the <file>debian/rules</file> file
10244 executable (see below).</p></item>
10249 If there is no original source code - for example, if the
10250 package is specially prepared for Debian or the Debian
10251 maintainer is the same as the upstream maintainer - the
10252 format is slightly different: then there is no diff, and the
10254 <file><var>package</var>_<var>version</var>.tar.gz</file>,
10255 and preferably contains a directory named
10256 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>.
10261 <heading>Unpacking a Debian source package without <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn></heading>
10264 <tt>dpkg-source -x</tt> is the recommended way to unpack a
10265 Debian source package. However, if it is not available it
10266 is possible to unpack a Debian source archive as follows:
10267 <enumlist compact="compact">
10270 Untar the tarfile, which will create a <file>.orig</file>
10274 <p>Rename the <file>.orig</file> directory to
10275 <file><var>package</var>-<var>version</var></file>.</p>
10279 Create the subdirectory <file>debian</file> at the top of
10280 the source tree.</p>
10282 <item><p>Apply the diff using <tt>patch -p0</tt>.</p>
10284 <item><p>Untar the tarfile again if you want a copy of the original
10285 source code alongside the Debianised version.</p>
10290 It is not possible to generate a valid Debian source archive
10291 without using <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>. In particular,
10292 attempting to use <prgn>diff</prgn> directly to generate the
10293 <file>.diff.gz</file> file will not work.
10297 <heading>Restrictions on objects in source packages</heading>
10300 The source package may not contain any hard links
10302 This is not currently detected when building source
10303 packages, but only when extracting
10307 Hard links may be permitted at some point in the
10308 future, but would require a fair amount of
10310 </footnote>, device special files, sockets or setuid or
10313 Setgid directories are allowed.
10318 The source packaging tools manage the changes between the
10319 original and Debianised source using <prgn>diff</prgn> and
10320 <prgn>patch</prgn>. Turning the original source tree as
10321 included in the <file>.orig.tar.gz</file> into the debianised
10322 source must not involve any changes which cannot be
10323 handled by these tools. Problematic changes which cause
10324 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> to halt with an error when
10325 building the source package are:
10326 <list compact="compact">
10327 <item><p>Adding or removing symbolic links, sockets or pipes.</p>
10329 <item><p>Changing the targets of symbolic links.</p>
10331 <item><p>Creating directories, other than <file>debian</file>.</p>
10333 <item><p>Changes to the contents of binary files.</p></item>
10334 </list> Changes which cause <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> to
10335 print a warning but continue anyway are:
10336 <list compact="compact">
10339 Removing files, directories or symlinks.
10341 Renaming a file is not treated specially - it is
10342 seen as the removal of the old file (which
10343 generates a warning, but is otherwise ignored),
10344 and the creation of the new one.
10350 Changed text files which are missing the usual final
10351 newline (either in the original or the modified
10356 Changes which are not represented, but which are not detected by
10357 <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn>, are:
10358 <list compact="compact">
10359 <item><p>Changing the permissions of files (other than
10360 <file>debian/rules</file>) and directories.</p></item>
10365 The <file>debian</file> directory and <file>debian/rules</file>
10366 are handled specially by <prgn>dpkg-source</prgn> - before
10367 applying the changes it will create the <file>debian</file>
10368 directory, and afterwards it will make
10369 <file>debian/rules</file> world-executable.
10375 <appendix id="pkg-controlfields">
10376 <heading>Control files and their fields (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
10379 Many of the tools in the <prgn>dpkg</prgn> suite manipulate
10380 data in a common format, known as control files. Binary and
10381 source packages have control data as do the <file>.changes</file>
10382 files which control the installation of uploaded files, and
10383 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s internal databases are in a similar
10388 <heading>Syntax of control files</heading>
10391 See <ref id="controlsyntax">.
10395 It is important to note that there are several fields which
10396 are optional as far as <prgn>dpkg</prgn> and the related
10397 tools are concerned, but which must appear in every Debian
10398 package, or whose omission may cause problems.
10403 <heading>List of fields</heading>
10406 See <ref id="controlfieldslist">.
10410 This section now contains only the fields that didn't belong
10411 to the Policy manual.
10414 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Filename">
10415 <heading><tt>Filename</tt> and <tt>MSDOS-Filename</tt></heading>
10418 These fields in <tt>Packages</tt> files give the
10419 filename(s) of (the parts of) a package in the
10420 distribution directories, relative to the root of the
10421 Debian hierarchy. If the package has been split into
10422 several parts the parts are all listed in order, separated
10427 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Size">
10428 <heading><tt>Size</tt> and <tt>MD5sum</tt></heading>
10431 These fields in <file>Packages</file> files give the size (in
10432 bytes, expressed in decimal) and MD5 checksum of the
10433 file(s) which make(s) up a binary package in the
10434 distribution. If the package is split into several parts
10435 the values for the parts are listed in order, separated by
10440 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Status">
10441 <heading><tt>Status</tt></heading>
10444 This field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file records
10445 whether the user wants a package installed, removed or
10446 left alone, whether it is broken (requiring
10447 re-installation) or not and what its current state on the
10448 system is. Each of these pieces of information is a
10453 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Config-Version">
10454 <heading><tt>Config-Version</tt></heading>
10457 If a package is not installed or not configured, this
10458 field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file records the last
10459 version of the package which was successfully
10464 <sect1 id="pkg-f-Conffiles">
10465 <heading><tt>Conffiles</tt></heading>
10468 This field in <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s status file contains
10469 information about the automatically-managed configuration
10470 files held by a package. This field should <em>not</em>
10471 appear anywhere in a package!
10476 <heading>Obsolete fields</heading>
10479 These are still recognized by <prgn>dpkg</prgn> but should
10480 not appear anywhere any more.
10482 <taglist compact="compact">
10484 <tag><tt>Revision</tt></tag>
10485 <tag><tt>Package-Revision</tt></tag>
10486 <tag><tt>Package_Revision</tt></tag>
10488 The Debian revision part of the package version was
10489 at one point in a separate control file field. This
10490 field went through several names.
10493 <tag><tt>Recommended</tt></tag>
10494 <item>Old name for <tt>Recommends</tt>.</item>
10496 <tag><tt>Optional</tt></tag>
10497 <item>Old name for <tt>Suggests</tt>.</item>
10499 <tag><tt>Class</tt></tag>
10500 <item>Old name for <tt>Priority</tt>.</item>
10509 <appendix id="pkg-conffiles">
10510 <heading>Configuration file handling (from old Packaging Manual)</heading>
10513 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> can do a certain amount of automatic
10514 handling of package configuration files.
10518 Whether this mechanism is appropriate depends on a number of
10519 factors, but basically there are two approaches to any
10520 particular configuration file.
10524 The easy method is to ship a best-effort configuration in the
10525 package, and use <prgn>dpkg</prgn>'s conffile mechanism to
10526 handle updates. If the user is unlikely to want to edit the
10527 file, but you need them to be able to without losing their
10528 changes, and a new package with a changed version of the file
10529 is only released infrequently, this is a good approach.
10533 The hard method is to build the configuration file from
10534 scratch in the <prgn>postinst</prgn> script, and to take the
10535 responsibility for fixing any mistakes made in earlier
10536 versions of the package automatically. This will be
10537 appropriate if the file is likely to need to be different on
10541 <sect><heading>Automatic handling of configuration files by
10546 A package may contain a control area file called
10547 <tt>conffiles</tt>. This file should be a list of filenames
10548 of configuration files needing automatic handling, separated
10549 by newlines. The filenames should be absolute pathnames,
10550 and the files referred to should actually exist in the
10555 When a package is upgraded <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will process
10556 the configuration files during the configuration stage,
10557 shortly before it runs the package's <prgn>postinst</prgn>
10562 For each file it checks to see whether the version of the
10563 file included in the package is the same as the one that was
10564 included in the last version of the package (the one that is
10565 being upgraded from); it also compares the version currently
10566 installed on the system with the one shipped with the last
10571 If neither the user nor the package maintainer has changed
10572 the file, it is left alone. If one or the other has changed
10573 their version, then the changed version is preferred - i.e.,
10574 if the user edits their file, but the package maintainer
10575 doesn't ship a different version, the user's changes will
10576 stay, silently, but if the maintainer ships a new version
10577 and the user hasn't edited it the new version will be
10578 installed (with an informative message). If both have
10579 changed their version the user is prompted about the problem
10580 and must resolve the differences themselves.
10584 The comparisons are done by calculating the MD5 message
10585 digests of the files, and storing the MD5 of the file as it
10586 was included in the most recent version of the package.
10590 When a package is installed for the first time
10591 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will install the file that comes with it,
10592 unless that would mean overwriting a file already on the
10597 However, note that <prgn>dpkg</prgn> will <em>not</em>
10598 replace a conffile that was removed by the user (or by a
10599 script). This is necessary because with some programs a
10600 missing file produces an effect hard or impossible to
10601 achieve in another way, so that a missing file needs to be
10602 kept that way if the user did it.
10606 Note that a package should <em>not</em> modify a
10607 <prgn>dpkg</prgn>-handled conffile in its maintainer
10608 scripts. Doing this will lead to <prgn>dpkg</prgn> giving
10609 the user confusing and possibly dangerous options for
10610 conffile update when the package is upgraded.</p>
10613 <sect><heading>Fully-featured maintainer script configuration
10618 For files which contain site-specific information such as
10619 the hostname and networking details and so forth, it is
10620 better to create the file in the package's
10621 <prgn>postinst</prgn> script.
10625 This will typically involve examining the state of the rest
10626 of the system to determine values and other information, and
10627 may involve prompting the user for some information which
10628 can't be obtained some other way.
10632 When using this method there are a couple of important
10633 issues which should be considered:
10637 If you discover a bug in the program which generates the
10638 configuration file, or if the format of the file changes
10639 from one version to the next, you will have to arrange for
10640 the postinst script to do something sensible - usually this
10641 will mean editing the installed configuration file to remove
10642 the problem or change the syntax. You will have to do this
10643 very carefully, since the user may have changed the file,
10644 perhaps to fix the very problem that your script is trying
10645 to deal with - you will have to detect these situations and
10646 deal with them correctly.
10650 If you do go down this route it's probably a good idea to
10651 make the program that generates the configuration file(s) a
10652 separate program in <file>/usr/sbin</file>, by convention called
10653 <file><var>package</var>config</file> and then run that if
10654 appropriate from the post-installation script. The
10655 <tt><var>package</var>config</tt> program should not
10656 unquestioningly overwrite an existing configuration - if its
10657 mode of operation is geared towards setting up a package for
10658 the first time (rather than any arbitrary reconfiguration
10659 later) you should have it check whether the configuration
10660 already exists, and require a <tt>--force</tt> flag to
10661 overwrite it.</p></sect>
10664 <appendix id="pkg-alternatives"><heading>Alternative versions of
10665 an interface - <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> (from old
10670 When several packages all provide different versions of the
10671 same program or file it is useful to have the system select a
10672 default, but to allow the system administrator to change it
10673 and have their decisions respected.
10677 For example, there are several versions of the <prgn>vi</prgn>
10678 editor, and there is no reason to prevent all of them from
10679 being installed at once, each under their own name
10680 (<prgn>nvi</prgn>, <prgn>vim</prgn> or whatever).
10681 Nevertheless it is desirable to have the name <tt>vi</tt>
10682 refer to something, at least by default.
10686 If all the packages involved cooperate, this can be done with
10687 <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn>.
10691 Each package provides its own version under its own name, and
10692 calls <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> in its postinst to
10693 register its version (and again in its prerm to deregister
10698 See the man page <manref name="update-alternatives"
10699 section="8"> for details.
10703 If <prgn>update-alternatives</prgn> does not seem appropriate
10704 you may wish to consider using diversions instead.</p>
10707 <appendix id="pkg-diversions"><heading>Diversions - overriding a
10708 package's version of a file (from old Packaging Manual)
10712 It is possible to have <prgn>dpkg</prgn> not overwrite a file
10713 when it reinstalls the package it belongs to, and to have it
10714 put the file from the package somewhere else instead.
10718 This can be used locally to override a package's version of a
10719 file, or by one package to override another's version (or
10720 provide a wrapper for it).
10724 Before deciding to use a diversion, read <ref
10725 id="pkg-alternatives"> to see if you really want a diversion
10726 rather than several alternative versions of a program.
10730 There is a diversion list, which is read by <prgn>dpkg</prgn>,
10731 and updated by a special program <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn>.
10732 Please see <manref name="dpkg-divert" section="8"> for full
10733 details of its operation.
10737 When a package wishes to divert a file from another, it should
10738 call <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> in its preinst to add the
10739 diversion and rename the existing file. For example,
10740 supposing that a <prgn>smailwrapper</prgn> package wishes to
10741 install a wrapper around <file>/usr/sbin/smail</file>:
10743 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --add --rename \
10744 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10745 </example> The <tt>--package smailwrapper</tt> ensures that
10746 <prgn>smailwrapper</prgn>'s copy of <file>/usr/sbin/smail</file>
10747 can bypass the diversion and get installed as the true version.
10748 It's safe to add the diversion unconditionally on upgrades since
10749 it will be left unchanged if it already exists, but
10750 <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn> will display a message. To suppress that
10751 message, make the command conditional on the version from which
10752 the package is being upgraded:
10754 if [ upgrade != "$1" ] || dpkg --compare-versions "$2" lt 1.0-2; then
10755 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --add --rename \
10756 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10758 </example> where <tt>1.0-2</tt> is the version at which the
10759 diversion was first added to the package. Running the command
10760 during abort-upgrade is pointless but harmless.
10764 The postrm has to do the reverse:
10766 if [ remove = "$1" -o abort-install = "$1" -o disappear = "$1" ]; then
10767 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --remove --rename \
10768 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10770 </example> If the diversion was added at a particular version, the
10771 postrm should also handle the failure case of upgrading from an
10772 older version (unless the older version is so old that direct
10773 upgrades are no longer supported):
10775 if [ abort-upgrade = "$1" ] && dpkg --compare-versions "$2" lt 1.0-2; then
10776 dpkg-divert --package smailwrapper --remove --rename \
10777 --divert /usr/sbin/smail.real /usr/sbin/smail
10779 </example> where <tt>1.02-2</tt> is the version at which the
10780 diversion was first added to the package. The postrm should not
10781 remove the diversion on upgrades both because there's no reason to
10782 remove the diversion only to immediately re-add it and since the
10783 postrm of the old package is run after unpacking so the removal of
10784 the diversion will fail.
10788 Do not attempt to divert a file which is vitally important for
10789 the system's operation - when using <prgn>dpkg-divert</prgn>
10790 there is a time, after it has been diverted but before
10791 <prgn>dpkg</prgn> has installed the new version, when the file
10792 does not exist.</p>
10797 <!-- Local variables: -->
10798 <!-- indent-tabs-mode: t -->
10800 <!-- vim:set ai et sts=2 sw=2 tw=76: -->